Yamaha RX-550 El manual del propietario

Categoría
Receptores AV
Tipo
El manual del propietario

Este manual también es adecuado para

RX-V550
AV Receiver
OWNER'S MANUAL
U
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 1 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
i
Explanation of Graphical Symbols
The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an
equilateral triangle, is intended to alert you to the
presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within
the product’s enclosure that may be of sufficient
magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to
persons.
The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle
is intended to alert you to the presence of important
operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in
the literature accompanying the appliance.
1 Read Instructions – All the safety and operating instructions
should be read before the product is operated.
2 Retain Instructions – The safety and operating instructions
should be retained for future reference.
3 Heed Warnings – All warnings on the product and in the
operating instructions should be adhered to.
4 Follow Instructions – All operating and use instructions
should be followed.
5 Cleaning – Unplug this product from the wall outlet before
cleaning. Do not use liquid cleaners or aerosol cleaners. Use
a damp cloth for cleaning.
6 Attachments – Do not use attachments not recommended by
the product manufacturer as they may cause hazards.
7 Water and Moisture – Do not use this product near water –
for example, near a bath tub, wash bowl, kitchen sink, or
laundry tub; in a wet basement; or near a swimming pool;
and the like.
8 Accessories – Do not place this product on an unstable cart,
stand, tripod, bracket, or table. The product may fall,
causing serious injury to a child or adult, and serious
damage to the product. Use only with a cart, stand, tripod,
bracket, or table recommended by the manufacturer, or sold
with the product. Any mounting of the product should
follow the manufacturer’s instructions, and should use a
mounting accessory recommended by the manufacturer.
9 A product and cart combination should be moved with care.
Quick stops, excessive force, and uneven
surfaces may cause the product and cart
combination to overturn.
10 Ventilation – Slots and openings in the cabinet are provided
for ventilation and to ensure reliable operation of the
product and to protect it from overheating, and these
openings must not be blocked or covered. The openings
should never be blocked by placing the product on a bed,
sofa, rug, or other similar surface. This product should not
be placed in a built-in installation such as a bookcase or rack
unless proper ventilation is provided or the manufacturer’s
instructions have been adhered to.
11 Power Sources – This product should be operated only from
the type of power source indicated on the marking label. If
you are not sure of the type of power supply to your home,
consult your product dealer or local power company. For
products intended to operate from battery power, or other
sources, refer to the operating instructions.
12 Grounding or Polarization – This product may be equipped
with a polarized alternating current line plug (a plug having
one blade wider than the other). This plug will fit into the
power outlet only one way. This is a safety feature. If you
are unable to insert the plug fully into the outlet, try
reversing the plug. If the plug should still fail to fit, contact
your electrician to replace your obsolete outlet. Do not
defeat the safety purpose of the polarized plug.
13 Power-Cord Protection – Power-supply cords should be
routed so that they are not likely to be walked on or pinched
by items placed upon or against them, paying particular
attention to cords at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the
point where they exit from the product.
14 Lightning – For added protection for this product during a
lightning storm, or when it is left unattended and unused for
long periods of time, unplug it from the wall outlet and
disconnect the antenna or cable system. This will prevent
damage to the product due to lightning and power-line
surges.
15 Power Lines – An outside antenna system should not be
located in the vicinity of overhead power lines or other
electric light or power circuits, or where it can fall into such
power lines or circuits. When installing an outside antenna
system, extreme care should be taken to keep from touching
such power lines or circuits as contact with them might be
fatal.
16 Overloading – Do not overload wall outlets, extension
cords, or integral convenience receptacles as this can result
in a risk of fire or electric shock.
17 Object and Liquid Entry – Never push objects of any kind
into this product through openings as they may touch
dangerous voltage points or short-out parts that could result
in a fire or electric shock. Never spill liquid of any kind on
the product.
18 Servicing – Do not attempt to service this product yourself
as opening or removing covers may expose you to
dangerous voltage or other hazards. Refer all servicing to
qualified service personnel.
19 Damage Requiring Service – Unplug this product from the
wall outlet and refer servicing to qualified service personnel
under the following conditions:
a) When the power-supply cord or plug is damaged,
b) If liquid has been spilled, or objects have fallen into the
product,
c) If the product has been exposed to rain or water,
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
CAUTION
CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF
ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE
COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE
PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO
QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page i Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
ii
EXAMPLE OF ANTENNA GROUNDING
MAST
GROUND
CLAMP
ANTENNA
LEAD IN
WIRE
ANTENNA
DISCHARGE UNIT
(NEC SECTION 810–20)
GROUNDING CONDUCTORS
(NEC SECTION 810–21)
GROUND CLAMPS
POWER SERVICE GROUNDING
ELECTRODE SYSTEM
(NEC ART 250. PART H)
ELECTRIC
SERVICE
EQUIPMENT
NEC – NATIONAL ELECTRICAL CODE
d) If the product does not operate normally by following
the operating instructions. Adjust only those controls
that are covered by the operating instructions as an
improper adjustment of other controls may result in
damage and will often require extensive work by a
qualified technician to restore the product to its normal
operation,
e) If the product has been dropped or damaged in any
way, and
f) When the product exhibits a distinct change in perfor-
mance - this indicates a need for service.
20 Replacement Parts – When replacement parts are required,
be sure the service technician has used replacement parts
specified by the manufacturer or have the same
characteristics as the original part. Unauthorized
substitutions may result in fire, electric shock, or other
hazards.
21 Safety Check – Upon completion of any service or repairs to
this product, ask the service technician to perform safety
checks to determine that the product is in proper operating
condition.
22 Wall or Ceiling Mounting – The unit should be mounted
to a wall or ceiling only as recommended by the
manufacturer.
23 Heat – The product should be situated away from heat
sources such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other
products (including amplifiers) that produce heat.
24 Outdoor Antenna Grounding – If an outside antenna or
cable system is connected to the product, be sure the antenna
or cable system is grounded so as to provide some
protection against voltage surges and built-up static charges.
Article 810 of the National Electrical Code, ANSI/NFPA 70,
provides information with regard to proper grounding of the
mast and supporting structure, grounding of the lead-in wire
to an antenna discharge unit, size of grounding conductors,
location of antenna discharge unit, connection to grounding
electrodes, and requirements for the grounding electrode.
Note to CATV system installer:
This reminder is provided to call the CATV system installer’s
attention to Article 820-40 of the NEC that provides
guidelines for proper grounding and, in particular, specifies
that the cable ground shall be connected to the grounding
system of the building, as close to the point of cable entry as
practical.
FCC INFORMATION (for US customers)
1 IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS
UNIT!
This product, when installed as indicated in the
instructions contained in this manual, meets FCC
requirements. Modifications not expressly approved by
Yamaha may void your authority, granted by the FCC, to
use the product.
2 IMPORTANT: When connecting this product to
accessories and/or another product use only high quality
shielded cables. Cable/s supplied with this product MUST
be used. Follow all installation instructions. Failure to
follow instructions could void your FCC authorization to
use this product in the USA.
3 NOTE: This product has been tested and found to comply
with the requirements listed in FCC Regulations, Part 15
for Class “B” digital devices. Compliance with these
requirements provides a reasonable level of assurance that
your use of this product in a residential environment will
not result in harmful interference with other electronic
devices.
This equipment generates/uses radio frequencies and, if
not installed and used according to the instructions found
in the users manual, may cause interference harmful to the
operation of other electronic devices.
Compliance with FCC regulations does not guarantee that
interference will not occur in all installations. If this
product is found to be the source of interference, which
can be determined by turning the unit “OFF” and “ON”,
please try to eliminate the problem by using one of the
following measures:
Relocate either this product or the device that is being
affected by the interference.
Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit
breaker or fuse) circuits or install AC line filter/s.
In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient
the antenna. If the antenna lead-in is 300 ohm ribbon lead,
change the lead-in to coaxial type cable.
If these corrective measures do not produce satisfactory
results, please contact the local retailer authorized to
distribute this type of product. If you can not locate the
appropriate retailer, please contact Yamaha Electronics
Corp., U.S.A. 6660 Orangethorpe Ave, Buena Park, CA
90620.
The above statements apply ONLY to those products
distributed by Yamaha Corporation of America or its
subsidiaries.
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page ii Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
CAUTION: READ THIS BEFORE OPERATING YOUR UNIT.
iii
1 To assure the finest performance, please read this
manual carefully. Keep it in a safe place for future
reference.
2 Install this sound system in a well ventilated, cool,
dry, clean place — away from direct sunlight, heat
sources, vibration, dust, moisture, and/or cold.
Allow ventilation space of at least 30 cm on the top,
20 cm on the left and right, and 20 cm on the back of
this unit.
3 Locate this unit away from other electrical
appliances, motors, or transformers to avoid
humming sounds.
4 Do not expose this unit to sudden temperature
changes from cold to hot, and do not locate this unit
in a environment with high humidity (i.e. a room with
a humidifier) to prevent condensation inside this
unit, which may cause an electrical shock, fire,
damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.
5 Avoid installing this unit where foreign object may
fall onto this unit and/or this unit may be exposed to
liquid dripping or splashing. On the top of this unit,
do not place:
Other components, as they may cause damage
and/or discoloration on the surface of this unit.
Burning objects (i.e. candles), as they may cause
fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.
Containers with liquid in them, as they may fall
and liquid may cause electrical shock to the user
and/or damage to this unit.
6 Do not cover this unit with a newspaper, tablecloth,
curtain, etc. in order not to obstruct heat radiation. If
the temperature inside this unit rises, it may cause
fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.
7 Do not plug in this unit to a wall outlet until all
connections are complete.
8 Do not operate this unit upside-down. It may
overheat, possibly causing damage.
9 Do not use force on switches, knobs and/or cords.
10 When disconnecting the power cord from the wall
outlet, grasp the plug; do not pull the cord.
11 Do not clean this unit with chemical solvents; this
might damage the finish. Use a clean, dry cloth.
12 Only voltage specified on this unit must be used.
Using this unit with a higher voltage than specified
is dangerous and may cause fire, damage to this
unit, and/or personal injury. YAMAHA will not be
held responsible for any damage resulting from use
of this unit with a voltage other than specified.
13 To prevent damage by lightning, disconnect the
power cord from the wall outlet during an electrical
storm.
14 Do not attempt to modify or fix this unit. Contact
qualified YAMAHA service personnel when any
service is needed. The cabinet should never be
opened for any reasons.
15 When not planning to use this unit for long periods
of time (i.e. vacation), disconnect the AC power plug
from the wall outlet.
16 Be sure to read the “TROUBLESHOOTING” section
on common operating errors before concluding that
this unit is faulty.
17 Before moving this unit, press STANDBY/ON to set
this unit in the standby mode, and disconnect the
AC power plug from the wall outlet.
18 VOLTAGE SELECTOR (Asia and General models
only)
The VOLTAGE SELECTOR on the rear panel of this
unit must be set for your local main voltage BEFORE
plugging into the AC main supply. Voltages are:
Asia model ...................... 220/230-240 V AC, 50/60 Hz
General model .. 110/120/220/230-240 V AC, 50/60 Hz
We Want You Listening For A Lifetime
YAMAHA and the Electronic Industries Association's Consumer
Electronics Group want you to get the most out of your
equipment by playing it at a safe level. One that lets the sound
come through loud and clear without annoying blaring or
distortion - and, most importantly, without affecting your
sensitive hearing.
Since hearing damage from loud sounds is often
undetectable until it is too late, YA M A H A and the
Electronic Industries Association’s Consumer
Electronics Group recommend you to avoid
prolonged exposure from excessive volume levels.
CAUTION: READ THIS BEFORE OPERATING YOUR UNIT.
WARNING
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC
SHOCK, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS UNIT TO RAIN
OR MOISTURE.
This unit is not disconnected from the AC power source as
long as it is connected to the wall outlet, even if this unit itself
is turned off. This state is called the standby mode. In this
state, this unit is designed to consume a very small quantity of
power.
FOR CANADIAN CUSTOMERS
To prevent electric shock, match wide blade of plug to
wide slot and fully insert.
This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian
ICES-003.
IMPORTANT
Please record the serial number of this unit in the space
below.
MODEL:
Serial No.:
The serial number is located on the rear of the unit.
Retain this Owner’s Manual in a safe place for future
reference.
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page iii Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
1
English
PREPARATIONINTRODUCTION
BASIC
OPERATION
SOUND FIELD
PROGRAMS
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
FEATURES............................................................. 2
GETTING STARTED............................................ 3
Supplied accessories .................................................. 3
Installing batteries in the remote control ................... 3
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS ......................... 4
Front panel ................................................................. 4
Remote control........................................................... 6
Using the remote control ........................................... 7
Front panel display .................................................... 8
Rear panel ................................................................ 10
SPEAKER SETUP ............................................... 11
Speaker placement ................................................... 11
Speaker connections ................................................ 12
CONNECTIONS .................................................. 14
Before connecting components................................ 14
Connecting video components................................. 15
Connecting audio components................................. 18
Connecting the antennas.......................................... 19
Connecting the power supply cord .......................... 20
Turning on the power............................................... 22
BASIC SETUP...................................................... 23
Using the BASIC SETUP menu.............................. 23
PLAYBACK.......................................................... 26
Basic operations....................................................... 26
Selecting sound field programs ............................... 28
Selecting input modes.............................................. 32
TUNING ................................................................ 34
Automatic and manual tuning.................................. 34
Presetting stations .................................................... 35
Selecting preset stations........................................... 37
Exchanging preset stations ...................................... 38
RECORDING ....................................................... 39
SOUND FIELD PROGRAM
DESCRIPTIONS...............................................40
For movie/video sources.......................................... 40
For music sources .................................................... 42
ADVANCED OPERATIONS ..............................43
Using the sleep timer ............................................... 43
Manually adjusting speaker levels........................... 44
Using the test tone ................................................... 44
SET MENU ............................................................45
Using SET MENU................................................... 46
1 SOUND MENU.................................................... 47
2 INPUT MENU...................................................... 49
3 OPTION MENU................................................... 50
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES ...................51
Control area ............................................................. 51
Setting manufacturer codes...................................... 52
Controlling other components ................................. 53
Clearing setup manufacturer codes.......................... 54
ZONE 2
(U.S.A., Canada and Australia models
only) ....................................................................55
Zone 2 connections .................................................. 55
Remote controlling Zone 2 ...................................... 56
EDITING SOUND FIELD PARAMETERS ......58
What is a sound field ............................................... 58
Changing parameter settings ................................... 58
SOUND FIELD PARAMETER
DESCRIPTIONS...............................................60
TROUBLESHOOTING .......................................62
RESETTING THE FACTORY PRESETS ........66
GLOSSARY...........................................................67
Audio formats .......................................................... 67
Sound field programs............................................... 68
Audio information ................................................... 68
Video signal information ......................................... 69
SPECIFICATIONS...............................................70
CONTENTS
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERATION
SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS
ADVANCED OPERATION
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 1 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
FEATURES
2
Built-in 6-channel power amplifier
Minimum RMS output power
(0.06% THD, 20 Hz – 20 kHz, 8)
Front: 90 W + 90 W
Center: 90 W
Surround: 90 W + 90 W
Surround back: 90 W
Sound field features
Proprietary YAMAHA technology for the creation of
sound fields
Dolby Digital/Dolby Digital EX decoder
DTS/DTS ES Matrix 6.1, Discrete 6.1, DTS Neo:6,
DTS 96/24 decoder
Dolby Pro Logic/Dolby Pro Logic II/Dolby Pro Logic
IIx decoder
Virtual CINEMA DSP
SILENT CINEMA
Sophisticated AM/FM tuner
40-station random access preset tuning
Automatic preset tuning
Preset station shifting capability (preset editing)
Other features
192-kHz/24-bit D/A converter
A SET MENU which provides you with items for
optimizing this unit for your audio/video system
6 additional input jacks for discrete multi-channel input
S-Video signal input/output capability
Component video input/output capability
Video signal conversion (Composite video S-Video)
capability for monitor out
Optical and coaxial digital audio signal jacks
Sleep timer
Cinema and music night listening modes
Remote control with preset manufacturer codes
Zone 2 custom installation facility (U.S.A., Canada and
Australia models only)
y indicates a tip for your operation.
Some operations can be performed by using either the buttons on the main unit or on the remote control. In cases when the button
names differ between the main unit and the remote control, the button name on the remote control is given in parentheses.
This manual is printed prior to production. Design and specifications are subject to change in part as a result of improvements, etc. In
case of differences between the manual and product, the product has priority.
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.
“Dolby”, “Pro Logic”, “Surround EX”, and the double-D symbol
are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
“SILENT CINEMA” is a trademark of YAMAHA
CORPORATION.
“DTS”, “DTS-ES”, “Neo:6” and “DTS 96/24” are trademarks of
Digital Theater Systems, Inc.
FEATURES
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 2 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
GETTING STARTED
3
English
INTRODUCTION
Please check that you received all of the following parts.
1 Press the part and slide the battery
compartment cover off.
2 Insert four supplied batteries (AAA, R03,
UM-4) according to the polarity markings
(+ and –) on the inside of the battery
compartment.
3 Slide the cover back until it snaps into place.
Notes on batteries
Change all of the batteries if you notice the condition like; the
operation range of the remote control decreases, the indicator
does not flash or its light becomes dim.
Do not use old batteries together with new ones.
Do not use different types of batteries (such as alkaline and
manganese batteries) together. Read the packaging carefully as
these different types of batteries may have the same shape and
color.
If the batteries have leaked, dispose of them immediately. Avoid
touching the leaked material or letting it come into contact with
clothing, etc. Clean the battery compartment thoroughly before
installing new batteries.
GETTING STARTED
Supplied accessories
TRANSMITCODE SET
STANDBY
SYSTEM
POWER
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-AU X
DVD
AMP
POWERPOWER
REC
AUDI O
MUTE
MENUTITLE
VOLUME
DISC SKIP
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
FREQ/RDS
EONSTARTMODE PTY SEEK
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
AVTV
SELECT
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
PRESET/CH
RAV251
WC55290 EU
Remote control
Batteries (4)
(AAA, R03, UM-4)
Indoor FM antenna
(U.S.A., Canada, China, Asia
and General models)
AM loop antenna
75-ohm/300-ohm antenna
adapter (U.K. model only)
Indoor FM antenna
(U.K., Europe, Australia
and Korea models)
Installing batteries in the remote
control
1
3
2
If the remote control is without batteries for more than
2 minutes, or if exhausted batteries remain in the
remote control, the contents of the memory may be
cleared. When the memory is cleared, insert new
batteries, set up the manufacturer code and program
any acquired functions that may have been cleared.
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 3 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
4
1 STANDBY/ON
Turns on this unit or sets it to the standby mode. When you
turn on this unit, you will hear a click and there will be a 4
to 5-second delay before this unit can reproduce sound.
In standby mode, this unit consumes a small amount of power in
order to receive infrared-signals from the remote control.
2 Remote control sensor
Receives signals from the remote control.
3 Front panel display
Shows information about the operational status of this
unit.
4 A/B/C/D/E (NEXT)
Selects one of the 5 preset station groups (A to E) when
the unit is in tuner mode.
Selects the speaker channel to be adjusted when the unit is
not in tuner mode.
5 PRESET/TUNING l / h (LEVEL –/+)
Selects preset station number 1 to 8 when the colon (:) is
displayed next to the band indication in the front panel
display when the unit is in tuner mode. Selects the tuning
frequency when the colon (:) is not displayed.
Adjusts the level of the speaker channel selected using
A/B/C/D/E (NEXT) when the unit is not in tuner mode.
6 MEMORY (MAN’L/AUTO FM)
Stores a station in the memory. Hold down this button for
more than 3 seconds to start automatic preset tuning.
7 TUNING MODE (AUTO/MAN’L MONO)
Switches between automatic tuning (AUTO indicator on)
and manual tuning (AUTO indicator off).
8 VIDEO AUX jacks
Input audio and video signals from a portable external
source such as a game console. To reproduce source
signals from these jacks, select V-AUX as the input source.
9 VOLUME
Controls the output level of all audio channels.
This does not affect the REC OUT level.
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
Front panel
AUTO/MAN'L MONOMAN'L/AUTO FMLEVELNEXTEDIT
EFFECT
MEMORYFM/AMPRESET/TUNING
A/B/C/D/E
PROGRAM
l PRESET/TUNING h
TUNING MODE
INPUT MODETONE CONTROLSTRAIGHT
SPEAKERS
PHONES
SILENT CINEMA
STANDBY
/ON
BA
MULTI CH
INPUT
VOLUME
INPUT
VIDEO L AUDIO R
VIDEO AUX
2134576
GHIEDB
9
8
0AC F
RDS MODE/FREQ EON
MODE
PTY SEEK
START
KLMJ
(U.S.A. model)
(U.K. and Europe models only)
Note
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 4 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
5
English
INTRODUCTION
0 PHONES (SILENT CINEMA) jack
Outputs audio signals for private listening with
headphones. When you connect headphones, no signals
are output to the OUTPUT jacks or to the speakers.
All Dolby Digital and DTS audio signals are mixed down
to the left and right headphone channels.
A SPEAKERS A/B
Turns on or off the set of front speakers connected to the A
and/or B terminals on the rear panel each time the
corresponding button is pressed.
B PRESET/TUNING (EDIT)
Switches the function of PRESET/TUNING l / h
(LEVEL –/+) between selecting preset station numbers
and tuning.
C STRAIGHT (EFFECT)
Switches the sound fields off or on. When STRAIGHT is
selected, input signals (2-channel or multi-channel) are
output directly from their respective speakers without
effect processing.
D FM/AM
Switches the reception band between FM and AM.
E PROGRAM
Use to select sound field programs or adjust the bass/treble
balance (in conjunction with TONE CONTROL).
F TONE CONTROL
Use to adjust the bass/treble balance for the front left and
right speakers (see page 27).
G INPUT MODE
Sets the priority (AUTO, DTS, ANALOG) for the type of
signals received when one component is connected to two
or more of this unit’s input jacks (see page 32).
H INPUT selector
Selects the input source you want to listen to or watch.
I MULTI CH INPUT
Selects the source connected to the MULTI CH INPUT
jacks. When selected, the MULTI CH INPUT source takes
priority over the source selected with INPUT (or the input
selector buttons on the remote control).
U.K. and Europe models only
J RDS MODE/FREQ
Press this button when the unit is receiving an RDS station
to cycle the display between the PS mode, PTY mode, RT
mode, CT mode (if the station offers those RDS data
services) and/or the frequency display.
K PTY SEEK MODE
Press this button to set the unit to the PTY SEEK mode.
L PTY SEEK START
Press this button to begin searching for a station after the
desired program type has been selected in the PTY SEEK
mode.
M EON
Press this button to select a radio program type (NEWS,
INFO, AFFAIRS, SPORT) to tune in automatically.
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 5 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
6
This section describes the function of each control on the
remote control used to control this unit. To operate other
components, see “REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES” on
page 51.
1 Infrared window
Outputs infrared control signals. Aim this window at the
component you want to operate.
2 CODE SET
Use to set up manufacturer codes (see page 52).
3 Input selector buttons
Select the input source and change the control area.
4 Sound field program / numeric buttons (1 - 8)
Use to select sound field programs.
Use numbers 1 through 8 to select preset stations when the
unit is in tuner mode.
5 NIGHT
Turns on or off the night listening modes (page 31).
6 LEVEL
Selects the speaker channel to be adjusted and sets the
level.
7 Cursor buttons u / d / j / i / SELECT
Use to select and adjust sound field program parameters or
SET MENU items.
Press u / d to select preset station numbers when the unit
is in tuner mode.
8 TEST (RETURN)
Outputs the test tone to adjust the speaker levels.
Returns to the previous menu level when adjusting the
SET MENU parameters.
9 TRANSMIT indicator
Flashes while the remote control is sending signals.
0 STANDBY
Sets this unit in the standby mode.
A SYSTEM POWER
Turns on the power of this unit.
B SLEEP
Sets the sleep timer.
C MULTI CH IN
Selects MULTI CH INPUT when using an external
decoder (etc.).
D AMP
Selects the AMP mode. You must select the AMP mode to
control the main unit.
E VOLUME/+
Increases or decreases the volume level.
F MUTE
Mutes the sound. Press again to restore the audio output to
the previous volume level.
G EX/ES
Switches between 5.1 or 6.1-channel playback of multi-
channel software.
Remote control
TRANSMITCODE SET
STANDBY
SYSTEM
POWER
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-AUX
DVD
AMP
POWERPOWER
REC
AUDIO
MUTE
MENUTITLE
VOLUME
DISC SKIP
FREQ/RDS
EONSTART
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
MODE PTY SEEK
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
AVTV
SELECT
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
PRESET/CH
9
0
A
B
C
D
E
F
H
I
J
1
2
3
4
5
7
8
6
G
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 6 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
7
English
INTRODUCTION
H STRAIGHT (EFFECT)
Switches the sound fields off or on. When STRAIGHT is
selected, input signals (2-channel or multi-channel) are
output directly from their respective speakers without
effect processing.
I SET MENU (A/B/C/D/E)
Activates the SET MENU function.
Selects preset station groups when the unit is in tuner
mode.
U.K. and Europe models only
J RDS tuning buttons
FREQ/RDS
Press this button when the unit is receiving an RDS station
to cycle the display between the PS mode, PTY mode, RT
mode, CT mode (if the station offers those RDS data
service) and/or the frequency display.
PTY SEEK MODE
Press this button to set the unit to the PTY SEEK mode.
PTY SEEK START
Press this button to begin searching for a station after the
desired program type has been selected in the PTY SEEK
mode.
EON
Press this button to select a radio program type (NEWS,
INFO, AFFAIRS, SPORT) to tune in automatically.
The remote control transmits a directional infrared beam.
Be sure to aim the remote control directly at the remote
control sensor on the main unit during operation.
Handling the remote control
Do not spill water or other liquids on the remote
control.
Do not drop the remote control.
Do not leave or store the remote control in the
following types of conditions:
high humidity such as near a bath
high temperature such as near a heater or stove
extremely low temperatures
dusty places
Using the remote control
RDS MODE/FREQ EON
MODE
PTY SEEK
START
AUTO/MAN'L MONOMAN'L/AUTO FMLEVELNEXTEDIT
EFFECT
MEMORYFM/AMPRESET/TUNING
A/B/C/D/E
PROGRAM
l PRESET/TUNING h
TUNING MODE
INPUT MODETONE CONTROLSTRAIGHT
SPEAKERS
PHONES
SILENT CINEMA
STANDBY
/ON
BA
MULTI CH
INPUT
VOLUME
INPUT
VIDEO L AUDIO R
VIDEO AUX
30 30
TRANSMITCODE SET
STANDBY
SYSTEM
POWER
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-AUX
DVD
AMP
POWERPOWER
REC
AUDIO
MUTE
MENUTITLE
VOLUME
DISC SKIP
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSICENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
AVTV
SELECT
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
PRESET/CH
Approximately 6 m (20 ft)
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 7 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
8
1 Decoder indicators
When any of this unit’s decoders function, the respective
indicator lights up.
2 SILENT CINEMA indicator
Lights up when headphones are connected and a sound
field program is selected (see page 27).
3 NIGHT indicator
Lights up when you select night listening mode.
4 Input source indicators
A cursor lights to show the current input source.
5 Sound field indicators
Light to indicate the active DSP sound fields.
6 CINEMA DSP indicator
Lights up when you select a CINEMA DSP sound field
program.
7 AUTO indicator
Lights up to indicate that automatic tuning is possible.
8 TUNED indicator
Lights up when this unit is tuned into a station.
9 STEREO indicator
Lights up when this unit is receiving a strong signal for an
FM stereo broadcast while the AUTO indicator is lit.
0 MEMORY indicator
Blinks to show that a station can be stored.
A MUTE indicator
Blinks while the MUTE function is on.
B VOLUME level indication
Indicates the volume level.
C PCM indicator
Lights up when this unit is reproducing PCM (pulse code
modulation) digital audio signals.
D VIRTUAL indicator
Lights up when Virtual CINEMA DSP is active (see
page 32).
E Headphones indicator
Lights up when headphones are connected.
F SP A B indicators
Light up according to the set of front speakers selected.
Both indicators light up when both sets of speakers are
selected.
G SLEEP indicator
Lights up while the sleep timer is on.
H HiFi DSP
Lights when you select a HiFi DSP sound field program.
I Multi-information display
Shows the current sound field program name and other
information when adjusting or changing settings.
J 96/24 indicator
Lights up when a DTS 96/24 signal is input to this unit.
Front panel display
CDTUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
96
24
q
PL
q
EX
q
PL
MATRIX DISCRETE
SILENT CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO MUTE
VOLUME
MEMORY
SLEEP
VIRTUAL
PCM
q
PL x
A B
SP
ft
mS
dB
dB
96/24
LFE
LCR
SL SB SR
q
DIGITAL
t
123456 780AB9
FG
M
N
HI KLJEDC
(U.S.A., Canada and
Australia models only)
(U.K. and Europe models only)
Presence DSP sound field
Listening position
Left surround
DSP sound field
Right surround
DSP sound field
Surround back DSP sound field
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 8 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
9
English
INTRODUCTION
K LFE indicator
Lights up when the input signal contains the LFE signal.
L Input channel indicators/speaker indicators
Indicate the channel components of the current digital
input signal.
Indicate the number of speakers connected in SPEAKERS
(page 24), or indicate the channel being adjusted in SP
LEVEL (page 48).
M ZONE 2 indicator
(U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only)
Lights up when Zone 2 power is on.
N RDS indicators
(U.K. and Europe models only)
The name(s) of the RDS data offered by the currently
received RDS station light(s) up.
EON lights up when an RDS station that offers the EON
data service is being received.
PTY HOLD lights up while searching for stations in the
PTY SEEK mode.
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 9 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
10
1 DIGITAL INPUT jacks
See pages 15, 17 and 18 for details.
2 MULTI CH INPUT jacks
See page 16 for connection information.
3 Video component jacks
See pages 15 and 17 for connection information.
4 REMOTE IN/OUT jacks
(U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only)
See page 55 for details.
5 CONTROL OUT jack
(U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only)
This is a control expansion terminal for commercial use.
6 AC OUTLET(S)
Use to supply power to your other A/V components (see
page 20).
7 DIGITAL OUTPUT jack
See page 18 for details.
8 Audio component jacks
See page 18 for connection information.
9 ZONE 2 OUTPUT jacks
(U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only)
See page 55 for details.
0 SUB WOOFER OUTPUT jack
See page 13 for connection information.
A Antenna terminals
See page 19 for connection information.
B Speaker terminals
See page 13 for connection information.
C IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch
See page 21.
< Asia and General models only >
FREQUENCY STEP switch
See page 19.
VOLTAGE SELECTOR
See page 20.
Rear panel
SPEAKERS
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
R
R
L
L
CENTER
SUB
WOOFER
MONITOR OUT
MULTI CH INPUT
OUTPUT
AUDIO
AUDIO
VIDEO
S VIDEO
DVD
DTV
/CBL
VIDEO
R
L
R
L
IN
(
PLAY
)
OUT
(
REC
)
MD
/CD-R
CD
OUT
ZONE 2
VCR
VIDEO
IN
FRONT
SURROUND
TUNER
AM
ANT
GND
COMPONENT VIDEO
P
R
DVD
MONITOR
OUT
DTV
/CBL
P
B
Y
DIGITAL
OUTPUT
DIGITAL
INPUT
OPTICAL
MD/CD-R
DVD
DTV/CBL
CD
COAXIAL
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
A
B
CONTROL
OUT
REMOTE
IN
OUT
+12V
15mA MAX.
FM
ANT
OPTICAL
SUB
WOOFER
S VIDEO
R
L
ZONE 2
IMPEDANCE SELECTOR
AC OUTLETS
SWITCHED
MD/CD-R
75 UNBAL.
12 3 5 64
7890A B C
(U.S.A. model)
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 10 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
SPEAKER SETUP
11
English
PREPARATION
The speaker layout below shows the standard ITU-R
speaker setting. You can use it to enjoy CINEMA DSP
and multi-channel audio sources.
Front speakers (FR and FL)
The front speakers are used for the main source sound plus
effect sounds. Place these speakers an equal distance from
the ideal listening position. The distance of each speaker
from each side of the video monitor should be the same.
Center speaker (C)
The center speaker is for the center channel sounds
(dialog, vocals, etc.). If for some reason it is not practical
to use a center speaker, you can do without it. Best results,
however, are obtained with the full system. Align the front
face of the center speaker with the front face of your video
monitor. Place the speaker centrally between the front
speakers and as close to the monitor as possible, such as
directly over or under it.
Surround speakers (SR and SL)
The surround speakers are used for effect and surround
sounds. Place these speakers behind your listening
position, facing slightly inwards, about 1.8 m (6 ft) above
the floor.
Surround back speaker (SB)
The surround back speaker supplements the surround
speakers and provides for more realistic front-to-back
transitions. Place this speaker directly behind the listening
position and at the same height as the surround speakers.
Subwoofer
The use of a subwoofer, such as the YAMAHA Active
Servo Processing Subwoofer System, is effective not only
for reinforcing bass frequencies from any or all channels,
but also for high fidelity reproduction of the LFE (low-
frequency effect) channel included in Dolby Digital and
DTS software. The position of the subwoofer is not so
critical, because low bass sounds are not highly
directional. But it is better to place the subwoofer near the
front speakers. Turn it slightly toward the center of the
room to reduce wall reflections.
SPEAKER SETUP
Speaker placement
60˚
30˚
SB
FL
FR
C
SL
SR
SR
80˚
SL
1.8 m (6 ft)
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 11 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
12
SPEAKER SETUP
Be sure to connect the left channel (L), right channel (R),
“+” (red) and “–” (black) properly. If the connections are
faulty, no sound will be heard from the speakers, and if the
polarity of the speaker connections is incorrect, the sound
will be unnatural and lack bass.
If you will use 6 ohm speakers, be sure to set
this unit’s speaker impedance setting to 6
ohms before using (see page 21).
Before connecting the speakers, make sure that the
power of this unit is off.
Do not let the bare speaker wires touch each other or do
not let them touch any metal part of this unit. This
could damage this unit and/or speakers.
Use magnetically shielded speakers. If this type of
speakers still creates the interference with the monitor,
place the speakers away from the monitor.
A speaker cord is actually a pair of insulated cables
running side by side. One cable is colored or shaped
differently, perhaps with a stripe, groove or ridges.
Connect the striped (grooved, etc.) cable to the “+” (red)
terminals on this unit and your speaker. Connect the plain
cable to the “–” (black) terminals.
1 Remove approximately 10 mm (3/8") of
insulation from the end of each speaker
cable.
2 Twist the exposed wires of the cable together
to prevent short circuits.
3 Unscrew the knob.
4 Insert one bare wire into the hole in the side
of each terminal.
5 Tighten the knob to secure the wire.
Banana plug connections
(With the exception of U.K., Europe and Asia models)
First, tighten the knob and then insert the banana plug
connector into the end of the corresponding terminal.
Speaker connections
CAUTION
10 mm (3/8")
1
2
Red: positive (+)
Black: negative (–)
3
4
5
Banana plug
(With the exception of U.K., Europe
and Asia models)
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 12 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
13
English
SPEAKER SETUP
PREPARATION
FRONT terminals
Connect one or two speaker systems to these terminals. If
you use only one speaker system, connect it to either the
FRONT A or B terminals.
The Canada model cannot output to two separate speaker systems
simultaneously.
CENTER terminals
Connect a center speaker to these terminals.
SURROUND terminals
Connect surround speakers to these terminals.
SUB WOOFER jack
Connect a subwoofer with built-in amplifier, such as the
YAMAHA Active Servo Processing Subwoofer System,
to this jack.
SURROUND BACK terminals
Connect a surround back speaker to these terminals.
SPEAKERS
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK
R
R
L
L
OUTPUT
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
A
B
SUB
WOOFER
2 3 6 71
54
Subwoofer
system
Center
speaker
Front speakers (A)
Surround back
speaker
LeftRight
LeftRight
Surround speakers
Front
speakers
(B)
(U.S.A. model)
Note
1
2
3
4
5
7
6
Speaker layout
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 13 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
CONNECTIONS
14
Do not connect this unit or other components to the mains
power until all connections between components are
complete.
Cable indications
Analog jacks
You can input analog signals from audio components by
connecting audio pin cable to the analog jacks on this unit.
Connect red plugs to the right jacks and white plugs to the
left jacks.
Digital jacks
This unit has digital jacks for direct transmission of digital
signals through either coaxial or fiber optic cables. You
can use the digital jacks to input PCM, Dolby Digital and
DTS bitstreams. When you connect components to both
the COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks, priority is given to
the input signals from the COAXIAL jack. All digital
input jacks are compatible with 96-kHz sampling digital
signals.
This unit handles digital and analog signals independently. Thus
audio signals input to the analog jacks are only output to the
analog OUT (REC) jacks. Likewise audio signals input to the
digital (OPTICAL or COAXIAL) jacks are only output to the
DIGITAL OUTPUT jack.
Dust protection cap
Pull out the cap from the optical jack before you connect
the fiber optic cable. Do not discard the cap. When you are
not using the optical jack, be sure to put the cap back in
place. This cap protects the jack from dust.
Video jacks
This unit has three types of video jacks. Connection
depends on the availability of input jacks on your monitor.
The signals input through the S VIDEO jacks on this unit
are automatically converted for output through the
VIDEO jacks. When V CONV. is set to ON (see page 50),
signals input through the VIDEO jacks can be output
through the S VIDEO jacks.
VIDEO jack
For conventional composite video signals.
S VIDEO jack
For S-Video signals, separated into luminance (Y) and
color (C) video signals to achieve high-quality color
reproduction.
COMPONENT VIDEO jacks
For component signals, separated into luminance (Y) and
color difference (P
B, PR) to provide the best quality in
picture reproduction.
When signals are input through both the S VIDEO and VIDEO
jacks, signals input through the S VIDEO jack have priority.
CONNECTIONS
Before connecting components
Note
CAUTION
S
V
O
V
V
V
L
R
C
left analog cables
right analog cables
optical cables
coaxial cables
video cables
S-Video cables
For analog signals
For digital signals
For video signals
Note
VIDEO
S VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
P
R
P
B
Y
S VIDEO
VIDEO
COMPONENT
VIDEO
Signal flow inside this unit
Only when V CONV. is set to ON
(see page 50).
Output
(MONITOR OUT)
Input
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 14 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
15
English
CONNECTIONS
PREPARATION
Connections for DVD playback
Connecting video components
MONITOR OUT
AUDIO
VIDEO
S VIDEO
DVD
VIDEO
R
L
VIDEO
COMPONENT VIDEO
PR
DVD
MONITOR
OUT
PB
Y
DVD
S VIDEO
LR
O
DVD player
Video
monitor
(U.S.A. model)
Optical out
Video out
Audio out
Video in
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 15 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
16
CONNECTIONS
Connecting to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks
This unit is equipped with 6 additional input jacks (left and right FRONT, CENTER, left and right SURROUND and
SUB WOOFER) for discrete multi-channel input from a multi-format player, external decoder, sound processor or pre-
amplifier.
Connect the output jacks on your multi-format player or external decoder to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks. Be sure to
match the left and right outputs to the left and right input jacks for the front and surround channels.
When you select MULTI CH INPUT as the input source, this unit automatically turns off the digital sound field processor, and you
cannot select sound field programs.
This unit does not redirect signals input to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks to accommodate for missing speakers. We recommend that
you connect at least a 5.1-channel speaker system before using this feature.
When headphones are used, only front left and right channels are output.
Notes
CENTER
SUB
WOOFER
MULTI CH INPUT
FRONT
SURROUND
R
L
LR
LR
Multi-format player/
External decoder
Front
out
Surround
out
Subwoofer
out
Center
out
(U.S.A. model)
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 16 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
17
English
CONNECTIONS
PREPARATION
Connections for other video components
VIDEO AUX jacks (on the front panel)
Use these jacks to connect any video source, such as a
game console or video camera, to this unit.
AUDIO
VIDEO
S VIDEO
DTV
/CBL
VIDEO
R
L
OUT
VCR
IN
COMPONENT VIDEO
PR
DTV
/CBL
PB Y
DIGITAL
INPUT
DTV/CBL
CD
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
O
LR
LR LR
Cable TV or
satellite tuner
(U.S.A. model)
DVD recorder
or VCR
Audio out
Video out
Optical out
Audio out Video out
Video in
Audio in
VIDEO L AUDIO R
VIDEO AUX
V
L
R
Game
console or
video camera
Video out
Audio out L
Audio out R
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 17 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
18
CONNECTIONS
Connections for audio components
Connecting audio components
AUDIO
R
L
IN
(
PLAY
)
(
REC
)
MD
/CD-R
CD
DIGITAL
OUTPUT
DIGITAL
INPUT
OPTICAL
MD/CD-R
CD
COAXIAL
MD/CD-R
L
R
LR LR
O
O
C
CD player
MD recorder or
tape deck
(U.S.A. model)
Coaxial out
Audio out
Audio in
Audio out
Optical in
Optical out
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 18 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
19
English
CONNECTIONS
PREPARATION
Both AM and FM indoor antennas are included with this
unit. In general, these antennas should provide sufficient
signal strength. Connect each antenna correctly to the
designated terminals.
Connecting the AM loop antenna
1 Set up the AM loop antenna, then connect it
to the terminals on this unit.
2 Press and hold the tab to insert
the AM loop antenna lead wires
into the AM ANT and GND
terminals.
3 Orient the AM loop antenna
for the best reception.
The AM loop antenna should be placed away from this unit.
The AM loop antenna should always be connected, even if an
outdoor AM antenna is connected to this unit.
A properly installed outdoor antenna provides clearer reception
than an indoor one. If you experience poor reception quality, an
outdoor antenna may improve the quality. Consult the nearest
authorized YAMAHA dealer or service center about outdoor
antennas.
75-ohm/300-ohm antenna adapter
(U.K. model only)
1 Open the cover of the
included 75-ohm/300-ohm
antenna adapter.
2 Cut the external sleeve
of the 75-ohm coaxial
cable and prepare it for
connection.
3 Cut the lead wire and
remove it.
4 Insert the cable
wire into the slot,
and clamp it with
pliers.
5 Snap the cover
into place.
FREQUENCY STEP switch
(Asia and General models only)
Because the interstation frequency
spacing differs in different areas, set
the FREQUENCY STEP switch
(locating on the rear panel) according
to the frequency spacing in your area.
North, Central and South America: 100 kHz/10 kHz
Other areas: 50 kHz/9 kHz
Before setting this switch, disconnect this unit’s power
cord from the AC wall outlet.
Connecting the antennas
TUNER
AM
ANT
GND
FM
ANT
75 UNBAL.
AM loop antenna
(included)
Ground (GND terminal)
For maximum safety and minimum interference,
connect the antenna
GND terminal to a good earth
ground. A good earth ground is a metal stake driven
into moist earth.
Indoor FM antenna
(included)
Notes
11 (7/16)
8 (5/16)
6 (1/14)
Unit:
mm (in.)
Lead wire
Clamp
Clamp
Insert wire into
slot.
10
K
H
Z
/ 100
K
H
Z
9
K
H
Z
/ 50
K
H
Z
FREQUENCY STEP
FMAM
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 19 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
20
CONNECTIONS
Connecting the AC power cord
Plug the power cord into an AC wall outlet.
AC OUTLET(S) (SWITCHED)
U.K. and Australia models .............................. 1 OUTLET
Korea model ...............................................................None
Other models ..................................................2 OUTLETS
Use these outlets to connect the power cords from your
other components to this unit. Power to the AC
OUTLET(S) is controlled by this unit’s STANDBY/ON
(or SYSTEM POWER and STANDBY). The outlet(s)
supply power to any connected component whenever this
unit is turned on. The maximum power (total power
consumption of components) that can be connected to the
AC OUTLET(S) is:
Asia and General models........................................... 50 W
Korea model ................................................................ N/A
Other models ...........................................................100 W
VOLTAGE SELECTOR
(Asia and General models only)
The VOLTAGE SELECTOR on the rear panel of this unit
must be set for your local main voltage BEFORE plugging
into the AC main supply. Voltages are:
Asia model ..........................220/230-240 V AC, 50/60 Hz
General model ......110/120/220/230-240 V AC, 50/60 Hz
Memory back-up
The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data from
being lost even if this unit is in the standby mode.
However if the power cord is disconnected from the AC
wall outlet, or the power supply is cut for more than one
week, the stored data will be lost.
Connecting the power supply cord
VOLTAGE
SELECTOR
VOLTAGE SELECTOR
(Asia and General models)
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 20 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
21
English
CONNECTIONS
PREPARATION
IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch
Do not change the setting of the IMPEDANCE
SELECTOR switch when the unit power is switched on,
as doing so may damage the unit.
If this unit fails to turn on when STANDBY/ON is pressed
on either the front panel or remote control, the
IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch may not be fully slid to
either position. If this is the case, slide the switch all the
way to either position when this unit is in standby mode.
Select the switch position (left or right) according to the
impedance of the speakers in your system.
*
The Canada model cannot use two separate speaker systems (A and B) simultaneously when the switch is set to the right position.
CAUTION
SET BEFORE POWER ON
IMPEDANCE SELECTOR
IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch
Switch position Speaker Impedance level
Left
Front
If you use one set (A or B), the impedance of each speaker must be
4 or higher.
If you use two sets (A and B), the impedance of each speaker must be
8 or higher.
The impedance of each speaker must be 6 or higher.Center, Surround, Surround back
Right
Front
If you use one set (A or B), the impedance of each speaker must be
8 or higher.
If you use two sets (A and B), the impedance of each speaker must be
16 or higher.
*
The impedance of each speaker must be 8 or higher.Center, Surround, Surround back
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 21 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
22
CONNECTIONS
When all connections are complete, turn on the power of
this unit.
1 Press STANDBY/ON (SYSTEM POWER on the
remote control) to turn on the power of this
unit.
2 Turn on the video monitor connected to this
unit.
Turning on the power
AUTO/MAN'L MONOMAN'L/AUTO FMLEVELNEXTEDIT
EFFECT
MEMORYFM/AMPRESET/TUNING
A/B/C/D/E
PROGRAM
l PRESET/TUNING h
TUNING MODE
INPUT MODETONE CONTROLSTRAIGHT
SPEAKERS
PHONES
SILENT CINEMA
STANDBY
/ON
BA
MULTI CH
INPUT
VOLUME
INPUT
VIDEO L AUDIO R
VIDEO AUX
1
TRANSMITCODE SET
STANDBY
SYSTEM
POWER
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-AU X
DVD
AMP
POWERPOWER
VOLUME
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
AVTV
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
1
(U.S.A. model)
STANDBY
/ON
SYSTEM
POWER
or
Front panel
Remote control
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 22 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
BASIC SETUP
23
English
PREPARATION
The basic setup feature is a useful way to set up your
system quickly and with minimal effort.
y
If you wish to configure the unit manually using more precise
adjustments, use the detailed parameters in SOUND MENU
(page 47) instead of using BASIC SETUP.
Altering any parameters in BASIC SETUP will reset all
parameters in SOUND MENU.
Before you begin:
Press SPEAKERS A or B on the front panel to select
the main speakers you want to use.
Make sure you disconnect your headphones from this
unit.
1 Press AMP.
2 Press SET MENU.
“BASIC SETUP” appears in the front panel display.
3 Press SELECT to enter BASIC SETUP.
The ROOM parameter appears in the front panel
display.
4 Press j / i to select the desired setting.
ROOM: S M >L
Select the size of the room you have installed your
speakers in. Roughly speaking, the room sizes are
defined as follows:
[U.S.A. and Canada models]
S (small) 16 x 13ft, 200ft
2
(4.8 x 4.0m, 20m
2
)
M (medium) 20 x 16ft, 300ft
2
(6.3 x 5.0m, 30m
2
)
L (large) 26 x 19ft, 450ft
2
(7.9 x 5.8m, 45m
2
)
[Other models]
S (small) 3.6 x 2.8m, 10m
2
M (medium) 4.8 x 4.0m, 20m
2
L (large) 6.3 x 5.0m, 30m
2
5 Press d to display the SUBWOOFER
parameter.
6 Press j / i to select the desired setting.
YES
If you have a subwoofer in your system.
NONE If you do not have a subwoofer in your system.
BASIC SETUP
Using the BASIC SETUP menu
TRANSMITCODE SET
STANDBY
SYSTEM
POWER
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-AU X
DVD
AMP
POWERPOWER
VOLUME
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
AVTV
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
REC
AUDIO
MENUTITLE
DISC SKIP
FREQ/RDS
EONSTART
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
MODE PTY SEEK
TEST
STRAIGHT
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
SELECT
PRESET/CH
1
3-13
2
AMP
MENU
SET MENU
A/B/C/D/E
BASIC SETUP
SELECT
PRESET/CH
SELECT
PRESET/CH
SUBWOOFER YES
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 23 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
24
BASIC SETUP
7 Press d to display the SPEAKERS
parameter.
8 Press j / i to select the number of speakers
you connected.
SPEAKERS 6spk
9 Press d to display SET/CANCEL.
10 Press j / i to select the desired setting.
>SET CANCEL
SET To apply the settings you chose in steps
4 through 8.
CANCEL To cancel the setup without making any
changes.
11 Press SELECT to confirm your selection.
If you selected SET, you hear a test tone from each
speaker in turn. “CHECK:Test Tone” appears in the
front panel display for a few seconds, then “CHECK:
OK?”.
CHECK:TestTone
CHECK OK? YES
12 Press j / i to select the desired setting.
CHECK OK? YES
YES To complete the setup process if the test tone
levels from each speaker were satisfactory.
NO To proceed to the SP LEVEL speaker level
adjustment menu to balance the level of each
speaker.
13 Press SELECT to confirm your selection.
If you selected NO in step 12, the front speaker level
adjustment display appears in the front panel display.
Choices Display Speakers
2spk
Front L/R
3spk
Front L/R, Center
4spk
Front L/R, Surround L/R
5spk
Front L/R, Center, Surround L/R
6spk
Front L/R, Center, Surround L/R,
Surround back
SELECT
PRESET/CH
LL C R
SL SB SR
LL C R
SL SB SR
LL CR
SL SB SR
LL C R
SL SB SR
LL C R
SL SB
SB
SR
LL C R
SL SB SR
SELECT
PRESET/CH
SELECT
PRESET/CH
SELECT
PRESET/CH
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 24 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
25
English
BASIC SETUP
PREPARATION
To balance the speaker levels
Perform the following steps after step 13 (see page 24).
The unit outputs the test tone from the selected speaker
and the left front (or left surround) speaker in turn. The
indicator of the speaker currently outputting the test tone
flashes in the front panel display.
1 Press d / u to select a speaker, then use j / i
to adjust the balance.
FR-----||-----
Adjusts the balance between the front left and right
speakers.
C-----||-----
Adjusts the balance between the front left and center
speakers.
SL-----||-----
Adjusts the balance between the front left and
surround left speakers.
SB-----||-----
Adjusts the balance between the surround left and
surround back speakers.
SR-----||-----
Adjusts the balance between the surround left and
surround right speakers.
SWFR-----||-----
Adjusts the balance between the front left speaker
and the subwoofer.
2 Press SET MENU to exit after balancing the
speakers.
y
You can also balance the speaker levels using test tone by
pressing TEST on the remote control.
CDTUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
96
24
q
PL
q
EX
MATRIX DISCRETE
SILENT CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO MUTE
VOLUME
MEMORY
SLEEP
VIRTUAL
PCM
q
PL
q
PL x
A B
SP
ft
mS
dB
dB
96/24
LFE
LR
SB
q
DIGITAL
t
FR-----||-----
C
SL SR
Memory back-up
The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data
from being lost even if this unit is in the standby mode.
However, if the power cord is disconnected from the
AC outlet, or the power supply is cut for more than one
week, the stored data will be lost. If so, adjust the
items again.
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 25 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
PLAYBACK
26
1 Press STANDBY/ON (SYSTEM POWER on
the remote control) to turn on the power.
2 Turn on the video monitor connected to this
unit.
3 Press SPEAKERS A or B on the front panel.
Each press turns the respective speakers on or off.
4 Select the input source.
Use INPUT (or press one of the input selector buttons
on the remote control) to select the input you desire.
The current input source name and input mode appear
in the front panel display and video monitor for a few
seconds.
5 Start playback or select a broadcast station
on the source component.
Refer to the operating instructions for the component.
6 Adjust the volume to the desired output
level.
PLAYBACK
Basic operations
AUTO/MAN'L MONOMAN'L/AUTO FMLEVELNEXTEDIT
EFFECT
MEMORYFM/AMPRESET/TUNING
A/B/C/D/E
PROGRAM
l
PRESET/TUNING
h
TUNING MODE
INPUT MODETONE CONTROLSTRAIGHT
SPEAKERS
PHONES
SILENT CINEMA
STANDBY
/ON
BA
MULTI CH
INPUT
VOLUME
INPUT
VIDEO L AUDIO R
VIDEO AUX
1 7 43 6
TRANSMITCODE SET
STANDBY
SYSTEM
POWER
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-AU X
DVD
AMP
POWERPOWER
VOLUME
TV VOL TV CH
AVTV
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
MUTE
VOLUME
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHT
q
/DTS
EFFECT
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
PRESET/CH
7
6
1
4
7
(U.S.A. model)
STANDBY
/ON
SYSTEM
POWER
Front panel Remote control
or
SPEAKERS
B
A
INPUT
Front panel
Remote control
or
CDTUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
96
24
q
PL
q
EX
MATRIX DISCRETE
SILENT CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO MUTE
VOLUME
MEMORY
SLEEP
VIRTUAL
PCM
q
PL
q
PL x
A B
SP
ft
mS
dB
dB
96/24
LFE
L C R
SL SB SR
q
DIGITAL
t
01DDVDD AUTO00
Selected input source
Input mode
VOLUME
VOLUME
or
Remote control
Front panel
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 26 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
27
English
PLAYBACK
BASIC
OPERATION
7 Select a sound field program if desired.
Rotate PROGRAM (or press AMP on the remote
control to select the AMP mode, then press one of the
sound field program buttons repeatedly) to select a
sound field program. (See page 40 for details about
sound field programs.)
To listen with headphones (SILENT CINEMA)
“SILENT CINEMA” allows you to enjoy multi-channel
music or movie sound, including Dolby Digital and DTS
surround, through ordinary headphones. “SILENT
CINEMA” activates automatically whenever you connect
headphones to the PHONES jack while listening to
CINEMA DSP or HiFi DSP sound field programs. When
activated, the “SILENT CINEMA” indicator lights up in
the front panel display.
This unit will not be set to “SILENT CINEMA” when MULTI
CH INPUT is selected as the input source.
“SILENT CINEMA” is not effective when the Direct Stereo or
2ch Stereo program is selected, or in STRAIGHT mode.
To adjust the tone
You can adjust the tonal quality
of your front left and right
speakers or headphones (when
connected).
Press TONE CONTROL on the
front panel repeatedly to select
TREBLE or BASS, then rotate
PROGRAM to the right or left to
increase or decrease.
Select TREBLE to adjust the
high frequency response.
Select BASS to adjust the low
frequency response.
To cancel the tone control, press TONE CONTROL
repeatedly to select BYPASS.
y
Speaker and headphone adjustments are stored independently.
If you increase or decrease the high-frequency or low-frequency
sound to an extreme level, the tonal quality of the surround
speakers may not match that of the front left and right speakers.
TONE CONTROL is not effective with the Direct Stereo
program (page 31) or MULTI CH INPUT.
To mute the sound
Press MUTE on the remote control.
The MUTE indicator blinks in the
front panel display.
To resume the audio output, press
MUTE again (or press VOLUME –/+).
The MUTE indicator disappears from
the display.
y
You can adjust the muting level (see page 49).
Notes
PROGRAM
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
AMP
Remote control
Front panel
or
Notes
TONE CONTROL
PROGRAM
MUTE
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 27 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
28
PLAYBACK
Selecting MULTI CH INPUT
Press MULTI CH INPUT so that “MULTI CH INPUT”
appears in the front panel display and video monitor.
MULTI CH INPUT
When “MULTI CH INPUT” is shown in the front panel display,
no other source can be played. To select another input source with
INPUT (or one of the input selector buttons), press MULTI CH
INPUT to turn off “MULTI CH INPUT” in the front panel
display.
Playing video sources in the
background
You can combine a video image from a video source with
sound from an audio source. For example, you can enjoy
listening to classical music while viewing beautiful
scenery from the video source on the video monitor.
Use the input selector buttons on the remote
control to select a video source, then select an
audio source.
If you want to enjoy audio from the MULTI CH INPUT jacks
together with a video source, first select the video source, then
press MULTI CH INPUT.
Front panel operation
Rotate PROGRAM to select the desired program.
The name of the selected program appears in the front
panel display and video monitor.
Note
Note
MULTI CH
INPUT
MULTI CH IN
Front panel
Remote control
or
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-AUX
DVD
AMP
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
Audio sources
Video sources
Selecting sound field programs
AUTO/MAN'L MONOMAN'L/AUTO FMLEVELNEXTEDIT
EFFECT
MEMORYFM/AMPRESET/TUNING
A/B/C/D/E
PROGRAM
l
PRESET/TUNING
h
TUNING MODE
INPUT MODETONE CONTROLSTRAIGHT
SPEAKERS
PHONES
SILENT CINEMA
STANDBY
/ON
BA
MULTI CH
INPUT
VOLUME
INPUT
VIDEO L AUDIO R
VIDEO AUX
PROGRAM
(U.S.A. model)
CDTUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
96
24
q
PL
q
EX
MATRIX DISCRETE
SILENT CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO MUTE
VOLUME
MEMORY
SLEEP
VIRTUAL
PCM
q
PL
q
PL x
A B
SP
ft
mS
dB
dB
96/24
LFE
L C R
SL SB SR
q
DIGITAL
t
01DJAZZA CLUBO00
Program name
PROGRAM
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 28 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
29
English
PLAYBACK
BASIC
OPERATION
Remote control operation
Press AMP to select the AMP mode, then press
one of the sound field program buttons
repeatedly to select the desired program.
The name of the selected program appears in the front
panel display.
y
Feel free to choose a sound field program based on your listening
preference, and not purely on the name of the program itself.
When you select an input source, this unit automatically selects
the last sound field program used with that source.
Sound field programs cannot be selected when MULTI CH
INPUT is selected.
Sampling frequencies higher than 48 kHz (except for DTS 96/
24 signals) will be sampled down to 48 kHz, then sound field
programs will be applied.
Enjoying multi-channel software
If you connected a surround back speaker, use this feature
to enjoy 6.1-channel playback for multi-channel sources
using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx, Dolby Digital Surround
EX or DTS-ES decoders.
Press AMP on the remote control to select the
AMP mode, then press EX/ES to switch between
5.1 and 6.1-channel playback.
To select a decoder, press j / i repeatedly while
PLIIxMusic (etc.) is displayed.
AUTO (AUTO)
When a signal (flag) that can be recognized by the unit is
input, the unit selects the optimum decoder for playing
back the signal in 6.1 channels.
If the unit cannot recognize the flag or no flag is present in
the input signal, it cannot automatically be played in 6.1
channels.
Decoders (select with j / i)
You can select from the following decoders depending on
the format of the software you are playing.
PLIIxMusic
For playing back Dolby Digital or DTS signals in 6.1
channels using the Pro Logic IIx music decoder.
EX/ES
For playing back Dolby Digital signals in 6.1 channels
using the Dolby Digital Surround EX decoder.
DTS signals are played back in 6.1 channels using the
DTS-ES decoder.
EX
For playing back Dolby Digital or DTS signals in 6.1
channels using the Dolby Digital Surround EX decoder.
OFF (OFF)
Decoders are not used to create 6.1 channels.
Notes
TRANSMITCODE SET
STANDBY
SYSTEM
POWER
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-AU X
DVD
AMP
POWERPOWER
VOLUME
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
AVTV
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
MUTE
MENUTITLE
VOLUME
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHT
q
/DTS
EFFECT
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
SELECT
PRESET/CH
Sound field
program
buttons
AMP
CDTUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
96
24
q
PL
q
EX
MATRIX DISCRETE
SILENT CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO MUTE
VOLUME
MEMORY
SLEEP
VIRTUAL
PCM
q
PL
q
PL x
A B
SP
ft
mS
dB
dB
96/24
LFE
L C R
SL SB SR
q
DIGITAL
t
01DJAZZACLUBO00
AMP
Program name
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
10
EX/ES
AMP
SELECT
PRESET/CH
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 29 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
30
PLAYBACK
Some 6.1-channel compatible discs do not have a signal (flag)
which this unit can automatically detect. When playing these
kinds of discs with 6.1-channel, select a decoder manually
(PLIIx Music, EX/ES or EX).
6.1-channel playback is not possible even if EX/ES is pressed in
the following cases:
When “SURR LR” (see page 47) or “SURR B” (see page 47)
is set to NONE.
When the source connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jack is
being played.
When the source being played does not contain surround left
and right channel signals.
When a Dolby Digital KARAOKE source is being played.
When “2ch Stereo” or “Direct Stereo” is selected.
When the power of this unit is turned off, the input mode will be
reset to AUTO.
When the DTS-ES decoder is applied to DTS 96/24 signals, you
cannot use the DTS 96/24 decoding feature.
The Pro Logic IIx decoder is not available when “SURR B” is
set to NONE (see page 47).
Enjoying 2-channel software
Signals input from 2-channel sources can also be played
back on multiple channels.
Press q/DTS on the remote control to select the
decoder.
You can select from the following decoders depending on
the type of software you are playing and your personal
preference.
PRO LOGIC SUR. STANDARD
Standard processing for Dolby Surround sources.
PRO LOGIC SUR. ENHANCED
CINEMA DSP enhanced processing for Dolby Surround
sources.
PRO LOGIC IIx Movie
*
Dolby Pro Logic II/IIx processing for movie software.
PRO LOGIC IIx Music
*
Dolby Pro Logic II/IIx processing for music software.
PRO LOGIC IIx Game
*
Dolby Pro Logic II/IIx processing for game software.
DTS Neo:6 Cinema
DTS processing for movie software.
DTS Neo:6 Music
DTS processing for music software.
*
Use the PLII/PLIIx parameter to select the Pro Logic II or Pro
Logic IIx decoders (see page 41).
The Pro Logic IIx decoder is not available when “SURR B” is set
to NONE (see page 47).
Notes
Note
9
q
/DTS
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 30 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
31
English
PLAYBACK
BASIC
OPERATION
Listening to high fidelity stereo sound
(Direct Stereo)
Direct Stereo allows you to bypass this unit’s decoders and
DSP processors to enjoy pure high fidelity sound from 2-
channel PCM and analog sources.
Rotate PROGRAM (or press AMP to select the
AMP mode, then press STEREO repeatedly) to
select “Direct Stereo”.
Direct Stereo
To avoid unexpected noise, do not play DTS-encoded CDs in
this mode.
When multi-channel signals (Dolby Digital and DTS) are input,
this unit automatically switches to the corresponding analog
input. (When DTS is selected as an input mode, no sound will
be heard.)
No sound will be output from the subwoofer.
TONE CONTROL (page 27) and SET MENU (page 45)
settings are not effective.
The front panel display automatically dims.
Night listening modes
The night listening modes are designed to improve
listenability at lower volumes or at night. Choose either
NIGHT:CINEMA or NIGHT:MUSIC depending on the
type of material you are playing.
Press NIGHT on the remote control repeatedly to
select cinema or music.
When night listening is selected, the NIGHT indicator in
the front panel display lights up.
Select NIGHT:CINEMA when watching films to
reduce the dynamic range of film soundtracks and
make dialog easier to hear at lower volumes.
Select NIGHT:MUSIC when listening to music sources
to preserve ease-of-listening for all sounds.
Select OFF if you do not want to use this function.
Press j / i to adjust the effect level while
NIGHT:CINEMA or NIGHT:MUSIC is displayed.
This adjusts the level of compression.
Select MIN for minimum compression.
Select MID for standard compression.
Select MAX for maximum compression.
y
NIGHT:CINEMA and NIGHT:MUSIC adjustments are stored
independently.
You cannot use the night listening modes with the Direct Stereo
program or MULTI CH INPUT (even though the NIGHT
indicator lights up when Direct Stereo is selected).
The night listening modes may vary in effectiveness depending
on the input source and surround sound settings you use.
Notes
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
AMP
Front panel
or
PROGRAM
Remote control
Notes
0
NIGHT
Remote control
SELECT
PRESET/CH
Remote control
Effect.Lvl:MID
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 31 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
32
PLAYBACK
Downmixing to 2 channels
You can enjoy 2-channel stereo playback even from multi-
channel sources.
Rotate PROGRAM (or press STEREO on the
remote control) to select 2ch Stereo.
2ch Stereo
y
You can use a subwoofer with this program when SWFR or
BOTH is selected in “BASS OUT”.
Listening to unprocessed input signals
In STRAIGHT mode, two channel stereo sources are
output from only the front left and right speakers. Multi-
channel sources are decoded straight into the appropriate
channels without any additional effect processing.
Press STRAIGHT (EFFECT) to select STRAIGHT.
STRAIGHT
Press STRAIGHT (EFFECT) again so that “STRAIGHT”
disappears from the display when you want to turn the
sound effect back on.
Virtual CINEMA DSP
Virtual CINEMA DSP allows you to enjoy the CINEMA
DSP programs without surround speakers. It creates
virtual speakers to reproduce the natural sound field.
If you do not connect surround speakers, Virtual CINEMA
DSP activates automatically whenever you select a
CINEMA DSP sound field program.
Virtual CINEMA DSP will not activate, even when “SURR LR”
is set to NONE (see page 47) in the following cases:
When MULTI CH INPUT is selected as the input source.
When headphones are connected to the PHONES jack.
This unit comes with a variety of input jacks. Do the
following to select the type of input signals you want to
use.
1 Rotate INPUT to select the input source.
2 Press INPUT MODE to select an input mode.
In most cases, use AUTO.
AUTO Automatically selects input signals in
the following order:
1) Digital signals*
2) Analog signals
DTS Selects only digital signals encoded in
DTS. If no DTS signals are input, no
sound is output.
ANALOG Selects only analog signals. If no
analog signals are input, no sound is
output.
* If this unit detects a Dolby Digital or DTS signal, the
decoder automatically switches to the appropriate sound
field program.
y
You can adjust the default input mode this unit selects when the
power is turned on (see page 49).
Note
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
Front panel
or
PROGRAM
Remote control
EFFECT
STRAIGHT
STRAIGHT
ENTER
EFFECT
Front panel
Remote control
or
Selecting input modes
INPUT
INPUT MODE
CDTUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
96
24
q
PL
q
EX
MATRIX DISCRETE
SILENT CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO MUTE
VOLUME
MEMORY
SLEEP
VIRTUAL
PCM
q
PL
q
PL x
A B
SP
ft
mS
dB
dB
96/24
LFE
L C R
SL SB SR
q
DIGITAL
t
01DDVDD AUTO00
Input modeInput source
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 32 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
33
English
PLAYBACK
BASIC
OPERATION
When you play DTS-encoded CD/LDs with the input mode set
to AUTO:
This unit automatically switches to the DTS decoding mode.
The unit remains in DTS mode (and the t indicator may
flash) for up to 30 seconds after playback of the DTS source is
complete. To manually release the DTS mode, press INPUT
MODE to reselect AUTO.
The DTS decoding mode may be released if search or skip
operations are performed for more than 30 seconds. To
prevent this, press INPUT MODE to select DTS.
If the digital output data of the player has been processed in any
way, you may not be able to perform DTS decoding even if you
make a digital connection between this unit and the player.
Displaying the information about the input
source
You can display the type, format and sampling frequency
of the current input signal.
1 Select the input source.
2 Press AMP to select the AMP mode, then
press STRAIGHT (EFFECT) so that
“STRAIGHT” appears in the display.
STRAIGHT
3 Press u / d to display the following
information about the input signal.
(Format) Signal format display. When the unit
cannot detect a digital signal it
automatically switches to analog input.
in Number of source channels in the input
signal. For example, a multi-channel
soundtrack with 3 front channels, 2
surround channels and LFE, is
displayed as “3/2/LFE”.
fs Sampling frequency. When the unit is
unable to detect the sampling
frequency “Unknown” appears.
rate Bit rate. When the unit is unable to
detect the bit rate “Unknown” appears.
flg Flag data encoded with DTS or Dolby
Digital signals that cue this unit to
automatically switch decoders.
Notes
STRAIGHT
ENTER
EFFECT
AMP
then
SELECT
PRESET/CH
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 33 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
TUNING
34
There are 2 tuning methods; automatic and manual.
Automatic tuning is effective when station signals are
strong and there is no interference.
Automatic tuning
1 Rotate INPUT to select TUNER as the input
source.
2 Press FM/AM to select the reception band.
“FM” or “AM” appears in the front panel display.
3 Press TUNING MODE (AUTO/MAN’L MONO)
so that the AUTO indicator lights up in the
front panel display.
If a colon (:) appears in the front panel display, tuning
is not possible. Press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) to
turn the colon (:) off.
4 Press PRESET/TUNING l / h once to begin
automatic tuning.
Press h to tune into a higher frequency, or press l
to tune into a lower frequency.
When tuned into a station, the TUNED indicator
lights up and the frequency of the received station is
shown in the front panel display.
TUNING
Automatic and manual tuning
AUTO/MAN'L MONOMAN'L/AUTO FMLEVELNEXTEDIT
EFFECT
MEMORYFM/AMPRESET/TUNING
A/B/C/D/E
PROGRAM
l
PRESET/TUNING
h
TUNING MODE
INPUT MODETONE CONTROLSTRAIGHT
SPEAKERS
PHONES
SILENT CINEMA
STANDBY
/ON
BA
MULTI CH
INPUT
VOLUME
INPUT
VIDEO L AUDIO R
VIDEO AUX
3 312 4
(U.S.A. model)
INPUT
Front panel
FM/AM
or
AM
FM
AUTO/MAN'L MONO
TUNING MODE
AUTO
Lights up
EDIT
PRESET/TUNING
TUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
T CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO ME
M
SLEEP
T
UAL
A B
SP
A
1
-AAM1 1440k kHz
TUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
T CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO ME
M
SLEEP
T
UAL
A B
SP
A
1
-AAM1 1530k kHz
LEVEL
l PRESET/TUNING h
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 34 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
35
English
TUNING
BASIC
OPERATION
Manual tuning
If the signal from the station you want to select is weak,
tune into it manually. Manually tuning into an FM station
will automatically switch the tuner to monaural reception
to increase the signal quality.
1 Select TUNER and the reception band
following steps 1 and 2 as described in
“Automatic tuning”.
2 Press TUNING MODE (AUTO/MAN’L MONO)
so that the AUTO indicator disappears from
the front panel display.
If a colon (:) appears in the front panel display, tuning
is not possible. Press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) to
turn the colon (:) off.
3 Press PRESET/TUNING l / h to tune into
the desired station manually.
Hold down the button to
continue searching.
Automatically presetting FM stations
You can use the automatic preset tuning feature to store
FM stations. This function enables this unit to
automatically tune into FM stations with strong signals,
and to store up to 40 (8 stations in 5 groups, A1 through
E8) of those stations in order. You can then recall any
preset station easily by selecting the preset station number.
1 Press FM/AM to select the FM band.
2 Press TUNING MODE (AUTO/MAN’L MONO)
so that the AUTO indicator lights up in the
front panel display.
If a colon (:) appears in the front panel display, tuning
is not possible. Press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) to
turn the colon (:) off.
AUTO/MAN'L MONO
TUNING MODE
AUTO
Disappears
TUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
T CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO ME
M
SLEEP
T
UAL
A B
SP
A
1
-AAM1 1440k kHz
EDIT
PRESET/TUNING
LEVEL
l PRESET/TUNING h
Presetting stations
AUTO/MAN'L MONOMAN'L/AUTO FMLEVELNEXTEDIT
EFFECT
MEMORYFM/AMPRESET/TUNING
A/B/C/D/E
PROGRAM
l
PRESET/TUNING
h
TUNING MODE
INPUT MODETONE CONTROLSTRAIGHT
SPEAKERS
PHONES
SILENT CINEMA
STANDBY
/ON
BA
MULTI CH
INPUT
VOLUME
INPUT
VIDEO L AUDIO R
VIDEO AUX
231
(U.S.A. model)
FM/AM
FM
AUTO/MAN'L MONO
TUNING MODE
AUTO
Lights up
TUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
T CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO ME
M
SLEEP
T
UAL
A B
SP
A
1
-AAM1 1440k kHz
EDIT
PRESET/TUNING
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 35 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
36
TUNING
3 Press and hold MEMORY (MAN’L/AUTO FM)
for more than 3 seconds.
The preset number, the MEMORY and AUTO
indicators flash. After about 5 seconds, automatic
presetting starts from the frequency currently
displayed and proceeds toward the higher
frequencies.
When automatic preset tuning is completed, the front
panel display shows the frequency of the last preset
station.
Any stored station data existing under a preset number is
cleared when you store a new station under that preset number.
If the number of the received stations does not reach 40 (E8),
automatic preset tuning has automatically stopped after
searching all stations.
Only FM stations with sufficient signal strength are stored
automatically by automatic preset tuning. If the station you
want to store is weak in signal strength, tune into it manually
and store it by following the procedure in “Manually presetting
stations”.
Automatic preset tuning options
You can select the preset number from which this unit will
store FM stations and/or begin tuning toward lower
frequencies.
After pressing MEMORY in step 3:
1 Press A/B/C/D/E, then PRESET/TUNING l / h to
select the preset number under which the first station
will be stored. Automatic preset tuning will stop when
stations have all been stored up to E8.
2 Press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) to turn off the colon
(:) and then press PRESET/TUNING l to begin
tuning toward the lower frequencies.
Manually presetting stations
You can also store up to 40 stations (8 stations x 5 groups)
manually.
1 Tune into a station.
See page 34 for tuning instructions.
When tuned into a station, the front panel display
shows the frequency of the station received.
2 Press MEMORY (MAN’L/AUTO FM).
The MEMORY indicator flashes for about 5 seconds.
3 Press A/B/C/D/E repeatedly to select a preset
station group (A to E) while the MEMORY
indicator is flashing.
The group letter appears. Check that the colon (:)
appears in the front panel display.
Notes
Memory back-up
The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data
from being lost even if this unit is set in the standby
mode, the power cord is disconnected from the AC
outlet, or the power supply is temporarily cut due to
power failure. However, if the power is cut for more
than one week, the preset stations may be cleared. If
so, store the stations again by using the presetting
station methods.
MAN'L/AUTO FM
MEMORY
CDTUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
96
24
q
PL
q
EX
MATRIX DISCRETE
SILENT CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO MUTE
VOLUME
MEMORY
SLEEP
VIRTUAL
PCM
q
PL
q
PL x
A B
SP
ft
mS
dB
dB
96/24
LFE
L C R
SL SB SR
q
DIGITAL
t
A1 1:FM1 87.5k MHz
AUTO/MAN'L MONOMAN'L/AUTO FMLEVELNEXTEDIT
EFFECT
MEMORYFM/AMPRESET/TUNING
A/B/C/D/E
PROGRAM
l
PRESET/TUNING
h
TUNING MODE
INPUT MODETONE CONTROLSTRAIGHT
SPEAKERS
PHONES
SILENT CINEMA
STANDBY
/ON
BA
MULTI CH
INPUT
VOLUME
INPUT
VIDEO L AUDIO R
VIDEO AUX
43 2,5
(U.S.A. model)
CDTUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
96
24
q
PL
q
EX
MATRIX DISCRETE
SILENT CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO MUTE
VOLUME
MEMORY
SLEEP
VIRTUAL
PCM
q
PL
q
PL x
A B
SP
ft
mS
dB
dB
96/24
LFE
L C R
SL SB SR
q
DIGITAL
t
A11:AM18630kkHz
MAN'L/AUTO FM
MEMORY
MEMORY
Flashes
NEXT
A/B/C/D/E
CDTUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
96
24
q
PL
q
EX
MATRIX DISCRETE
SILENT CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO MUTE
VOLUME
MEMORY
SLEEP
VIRTUAL
PCM
q
PL
q
PL x
A B
SP
ft
mS
dB
dB
96/24
LFE
L C R
SL SB SR
q
DIGITAL
t
C11:AM18630kkHz
Preset group
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 36 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
37
English
TUNING
BASIC
OPERATION
4 Press PRESET/TUNING l / h to select a
preset station number (1 through 8) while the
MEMORY indicator is flashing.
Press h to select a higher preset station number.
Press l to select a lower preset station number.
5 Press MEMORY (MAN’L/AUTO FM) on the
front panel while the MEMORY indicator is
flashing.
The station band and
frequency appear in the front
panel display with the preset
group and number you have
selected.
6 Repeat steps 1 to 5 to store other stations.
Any stored station data existing under a preset number is
cleared when you store a new station under that preset number.
The reception mode (stereo or monaural) is stored along with
the station frequency.
You can tune any desired station simply by selecting the
preset station number under which it was stored.
When performing this operation with the remote
control, first press TUNER to set the remote to
tuner mode.
1 Press A/B/C/D/E to select the preset station
group.
The preset group letter appears in the front panel
display and changes each time you press the button.
2 Press PRESET/TUNING l / h (PRESET/CH
u / d on the remote control) to select a
preset station number (1 to 8).
The preset group and number appear in the front
panel display along with the station band, frequency
and the TUNED indicator lights up.
Notes
LEVEL
l
PRESET/TUNING
h
CDTUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
96
24
q
PL
q
EX
MATRIX DISCRETE
SILENT CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO MUTE
VOLUME
MEMORY
SLEEP
VIRTUAL
PCM
q
PL
q
PL x
A B
SP
ft
mS
dB
dB
96/24
LFE
L C R
SL SB SR
q
DIGITAL
t
C1 3:AM18630k kHz
Preset number
MAN'L/AUTO FM
MEMORY
CDTUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
96
24
q
PL
q
EX
MATRIX DISCRETE
SILENT CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO MUTE
VOLUME
MEMORY
SLEEP
VIRTUAL
PCM
q
PL
q
PL x
A B
SP
ft
mS
dB
dB
96/24
LFE
L C R
SL SB SR
q
DIGITAL
t
C1 3:AM18630k kHz
Shows the displayed station has been stored as C3.
Selecting preset stations
AUTO/MAN'L MONOMAN'L/AUTO FMLEVELNEXTEDIT
EFFECT
MEMORYFM/AMPRESET/TUNING
A/B/C/D/E
PROGRAM
l
PRESET/TUNING
h
TUNING MODE
INPUT MODETONE CONTROLSTRAIGHT
SPEAKERS
PHONES
SILENT CINEMA
STANDBY
/ON
BA
MULTI CH
INPUT
VOLUME
INPUT
VIDEO L AUDIO R
VIDEO AUX
2
1
REC
AUDI O
MENUTITLE
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
TEST
STRAIGHT
1009
ENTER
EX/ESNIGHT
q
/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
SELECT
PRESET/CH
2
1
(U.S.A. model)
NEXT
A/B/C/D/E
MENU
SET MENU
A/B/C/D/E
or
Front panel Remote control
LEVEL
l PRESET/TUNING h
CDTUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
SILENT CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO
M
MEMORY
SLEEP
VIRTUAL
x
A B
SP
ft
mS
dB
9
E1 1:FM1 87.5k MHz
SELECT
PRESET/CH
or
Front panel
Remote control
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 37 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
38
TUNING
You can exchange the assignment of two preset stations
with each other. The example below describes the
procedure for exchanging preset station “E1” with “A5”.
1 Select preset station “E1” using A/B/C/D/E
and PRESET/TUNING l / h.
See “Selecting preset stations”.
2 Press and hold PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) for
more than 3 seconds.
“E1” and the MEMORY indicator flash in the front
panel display.
3 Select preset station “A5” using A/B/C/D/E
and PRESET/TUNING l / h.
“A5” and the MEMORY indicator flash in the front
panel display.
4 Press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) again.
The stations stored at the two preset assignments are
exchanged.
Exchanging preset stations
AUTO/MAN'L MONOMAN'L/AUTO FMLEVELNEXTEDIT
EFFECT
MEMORYFM/AMPRESET/TUNING
A/B/C/D/E
PROGRAM
l
PRESET/TUNING
h
TUNING MODE
INPUT MODETONE CONTROLSTRAIGHT
SPEAKERS
PHONES
SILENT CINEMA
STANDBY
/ON
BA
MULTI CH
INPUT
VOLUME
INPUT
VIDEO L AUDIO R
VIDEO AUX
2,4 1,31,3
(U.S.A. model)
EDIT
PRESET/TUNING
CDTUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
SILENT CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO
M
MEMORY
SLEEP
VIRTUAL
x
A B
SP
ft
mS
dB
9
E1 1:FM1 87.5k MHz
CDTUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
SILENT CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO
M
MEMORY
SLEEP
VIRTUAL
x
A B
SP
ft
mS
dB
9
A1 5:FM1 90.6k MHz
LEVEL
l PRESET/TUNING h
NEXT
A/B/C/D/E
CDTUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
SILENT CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO
M
MEMORY
SLEEP
VIRTUAL
x
A B
SP
ft
mS
dB
9
E1 EDIT18E1-A5Hz
EDIT
PRESET/TUNING
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 38 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
RECORDING
39
English
BASIC
OPERATION
Recording adjustments and other operations are
performed from the recording components. Refer to the
operating instructions for those components.
1 Turn on the power of this unit and all
connected components.
2 Select the source component you want to
record from.
3 Start playback (or select a broadcast station)
on the source component.
4 Start recording on the recording component.
y
Do a test recording before you start an actual recording.
When this unit is set in the standby mode, you cannot record
between other components connected to this unit.
The setting of TONE CONTROL, VOLUME, “SP LEVEL”
(page 48) and the sound field programs does not affect recorded
material.
A source connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks of this unit
cannot be recorded.
S-Video and composite video signals pass independently
through this unit’s video circuits. Therefore, when recording or
dubbing video signals, if your video source component is
connected to provide only an S-Video (or only a composite
video) signal, you can record only an S-Video (or only a
composite video) signal to your VCR.
Digital signals input to the DIGITAL INPUT jacks are not
output to the analog AUDIO OUT (L/R) jacks for recording.
Likewise, analog signals input to the AUDIO IN (L/R) jacks are
not output to the DIGITAL OUTPUT jack. Therefore, if your
source component is connnected to provide only digital (or
analog) signals, you can only record digital (or analog) signals.
A given input source is not output on the same REC OUT
channel. (For example, the signal input from VCR IN is not
output on VCR OUT.)
Check the copyright laws in your country to record from
records, CDs, radio, etc. Recording of copyrighted material may
infringe copyright laws.
Special considerations when recording
DTS software
The DTS signal is a digital bitstream. Attempting to
digitally record the DTS bitstream will result in noise
being recorded. Therefore, if you want to use this unit to
record sources that have DTS signals recorded on them,
the following considerations and adjustments need to be
made.
For DVDs and CDs encoded with DTS, when your player
is compatible with the DTS format, follow its operating
instructions to make a setting so that the analog signal will
be output from the player.
RECORDING
AUTO/MAN'L MONOMAN'L/AUTO FMLEVELNEXTEDIT
EFFECT
MEMORYFM/AMPRESET/TUNING
A/B/C/D/E
PROGRAM
l
PRESET/TUNING
h
TUNING MODE
INPUT MODETONE CONTROLSTRAIGHT
SPEAKERS
PHONES
SILENT CINEMA
STANDBY
/ON
BA
MULTI CH
INPUT
VOLUME
INPUT
VIDEO L AUDIO R
VIDEO AUX
12
TRANSMITCODE SET
STANDBY
SYSTEM
POWER
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-AU X
DVD
AMP
POWERPOWER
VOLUME
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
AVTV
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
1
2
(U.S.A. model)
INPUT
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-AUX
DVD
AMP
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
or
Front panel Remote control
Notes
If you playback a video source that uses scrambled or
encoded signals to prevent it from being dubbed, the
picture itself may be disturbed due to those signals.
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 39 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
SOUND FIELD PROGRAM DESCRIPTIONS
40
This unit is equipped with a variety of precise digital decoders that allow you to enjoy multichannel playback from
almost any sound source (stereo or multichannel). This unit is also equipped with a YAMAHA digital sound field
processing (DSP) chip containing several sound field programs which you can use to enhance your playback experience.
Most of these sound field programs are precise digital recreations of actual acoustic environments found in famous
concert halls, music venues, and movie theaters.
y
The YAMAHA CINEMA DSP modes are compatible with all Dolby Digital, DTS, and Dolby Surround sources. Set the input mode to
AUTO (see page 32) to enable this unit to automatically switch to the appropriate digital decoder according to the input signal.
This unit’s DSP sound field programs are recreations of real-world acoustic environments made from precise measurements taken in
the actual hall, etc. Thus you may notice variations in the strength of the reflections coming from the front, back, left and right.
Feel free to choose a sound field program based on your listening preference, and not purely on the name of the program itself.
You can select from the following sound fields when playing movie or video sources. The sound fields marked “MULTI”
can be used with multi-channel sources, like DVD, digital TV, etc. Those marked “
2-CH” can be used with 2-channel
(stereo) sources like TV programs, video tapes, etc.
SOUND FIELD PROGRAM DESCRIPTIONS
Notes
For movie/video sources
Program Features Sources
STEREO:
2ch Stereo
Downmixes multi-channel sources to 2 channels (left and right) or plays back 2-channel
sources as is.
MULTI
2-CH
MUSIC VIDEO
This program lends an enthusiastic atmosphere to the sound, giving you the feeling you are at
an actual jazz or rock concert.
ENTERTAINMENT:
Game
This program adds a deep and spatial feeling to video game sounds.
TV THEATER:
Mono Movie
This program is provided for reproducing monaural video sources (such as old movies). The
program produces the optimum reverberation to create sound depth using only the presernce
sound field.
TV THEATER:
Variety/Sports
Though the presence sound field is relatively narrow, the surround sound field employs the
sound environment of a large concert hall. This effect enhances the experience of watching
various TV programs such as news, variety shows, music programs or sports programs.
MOVIE THEATER:
Spectacle
CINEMA DSP processing. This program creates the extremely wide sound field of a 70-mm
movie theater. It precisely reproduces the source sound in detail, making both the video and the
sound field incredibly real. This is ideal for any kind of video source encoded with Dolby
Surround, Dolby Digital or DTS (especially large-scale movie productions).
MOVIE THEATER:
Sci-Fi
CINEMA DSP processing. This program clearly reproduces dialog and sound effects in the
latest sound form for science fiction films, thus creating a broad and expansive cinematic space
amid silence. You can enjoy science fiction films in a virtual-space sound field that includes
Dolby Surround, Dolby Digital and DTS-encoded software employing the most advanced
techniques.
MOVIE THEATER:
Adventure
CINEMA DSP processing. This program is ideal for precisely reproducing the sound design of
the newest 70-mm and multichannel soundtrack films. The sound field is made to be similar to
that of the newest movie theaters, so the reverberations of the sound field itself are restrained
as much as possible.
MOVIE THEATER:
General
CINEMA DSP processing. This program is for reproducing sounds from 70-mm and
multichannel soundtrack films, and is characterized by soft and extensive sound field.
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 40 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
41
English
SOUND FIELD PROGRAM DESCRIPTIONS
SOUND FIELD
PROGRAMS
*
You can select either Pro Logic IIx or Pro Logic II processing using the PLII/PLIIx parameter on page 61.
DOLBY DIGITAL:
SUR. STANDARD
Standard 5.1-channel processing for Dolby Digital sources.
MULTI
DOLBY DIGITAL:
SUR. ENHANCED
CINEMA DSP enhanced processing for Dolby Digital sources.
DOLBY D EX:
SUR. STANDARD
Standard 6.1-channel processing for Dolby Digital sources.
DOLBY D EX:
SUR. ENHANCED
CINEMA DSP enhanced 6.1-channel processing (Dolby Digital EX) for Dolby Digital
sources.
DTS:
SUR. STANDARD
Standard 5.1-channel processing for DTS sources.
DTS 96/24:
SUR. STANDARD
Standard 5.1-channel processing for 96-kHz/24-bit DTS sources.
DTS:
SUR. ENHANCED
CINEMA DSP enhanced processing for DTS and 96-kHz/24-bit DTS sources.
DTS+DOLBY EX:
SUR. STANDARD
Standard 6.1-channel processing (Dolby Digital EX) for DTS sources.
DTS+DOLBY EX:
SUR. ENHANCED
CINEMA DSP enhanced 6.1-channel processing (Dolby Digital EX) for DTS sources.
DTS ES Mtrx6.1:
SUR. STANDARD
Standard 6.1-channel processing (DTS-ES Matrix) for DTS sources.
DTS ES Mtrx6.1:
SUR. ENHANCED
CINEMA DSP enhanced processing (DTS-ES Matrix) for DTS sources.
DTS ES Disc6.1:
SUR. STANDARD
Standard 6.1-channel processing (DTS-ES Discrete) for DTS sources.
DTS ES Disc6.1:
SUR. ENHANCED
CINEMA DSP enhanced processing (DTS-ES Discrete) for DTS sources.
PRO LOGIC:
SUR. STANDARD
Standard processing for Dolby Surround sources.
2-CH
PRO LOGIC:
SUR. ENHANCED
CINEMA DSP enhanced processing for Dolby Surround sources.
PRO LOGIC IIx:
PLIIx Movie
Dolby Pro Logic IIx processing for movie software.
*
PRO LOGIC II:
PLII Movie
Dolby Pro Logic II processing for movie software.
*
PRO LOGIC IIx:
PLIIx Game
Dolby Pro Logic IIx processing for game software.
*
PRO LOGIC II:
PLII Game
Dolby Pro Logic II processing for game software.
*
DTS: Neo:6 Cinema
DTS processing for movie software.
Program Features Sources
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 41 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
42
SOUND FIELD PROGRAM DESCRIPTIONS
You can select from the following sound fields when playing music sources, like CD, FM/AM broadcasting, tapes, etc.
*
You can select either Pro Logic IIx or Pro Logic II processing using the PLII/PLIIx parameter on page 61.
For music sources
Program Features Sources
CONCERT HALL
HiFi DSP processing. A classic shoe-box type concert hall with approximately 1700 seats.
Pillars and ornate carvings create extremely complex reflections which produce a very full,
rich sound.
MULTI
2-CH
JAZZ CLUB
HiFi DSP processing. This is the sound field at stage front in “The Bottom Line”, a famous
New York jazz club. The floor can seat 300 people to the left and right in a sound field offering
a real and vibrant sound.
ROCK CONCERT
HiFi DSP processing. The ideal program for lively, dynamic rock music. The data for this
program was recorded at LAs “hottest” rock club. The listener’s virtual seat is at the center-
left of the hall.
ENTERTAINMENT:
Disco
HiFi DSP processing. This program recreates the acoustic environment of a lively disco in the
heart of a big city. The sound is dense and highly concentrated. It is also characterized by high-
energy, “immediate” sound.
q D+PLIIx Music:
SUR. STANDARD
Standard Dolby Digital and Dolby Pro Logic IIx processing for music sources.
MULTI
q D+PLIIx Music:
SUR. ENHANCED
CINEMA DSP enhanced Dolby Digital and Dolby Pro Logic IIx processing for music sources.
DTS+PLIIx Music:
SUR. STANDARD
Standard DTS and Dolby Pro Logic IIx processing for music sources.
DTS+PLIIx Music:
SUR. ENHANCED
CINEMA DSP enhanced DTS and Dolby Pro Logic IIx processing for music sources.
STEREO:
2ch Stereo
2-channel (left and right) playback.
2-CH
STEREO:
Direct Stereo
Use to output stereo sources to only the front left and right speakers without any processing.
STEREO:
6ch Stereo
Use to increase the output stereo sources (in stereo) from all speakers. This provides a larger
sound field and is ideal for background music at parties, etc.
PRO LOGIC IIx:
PLIIx Music
Dolby Pro Logic IIx processing for music software.
*
PRO LOGIC II:
PLII Music
Dolby Pro Logic II processing for music software.
*
DTS: Neo:6 Music
DTS processing for music software.
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 42 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
ADVANCED OPERATIONS
43
English
ADVANCED
OPERATION
Use this feature to automatically set this unit in the
standby mode after a certain amount of time. The sleep
timer is useful when you are going to sleep while this unit
is playing or recording a source. The sleep timer also
automatically turns off any external components
connected to the AC OUTLET(S).
Setting the sleep timer
1 Select a source and start playback on the
source component.
2 Press SLEEP repeatedly to set
the amount of time.
Each time you press SLEEP, the front
panel display changes as shown
below. The SLEEP indicator flashes
while switching the amount of time
for the sleep timer.
The SLEEP indicator lights up in the front panel
display, and the display returns to the selected sound
field program.
Canceling the sleep timer
Press SLEEP repeatedly until “SLEEP OFF” appears in
the front panel display.
After a few seconds, “SLEEP OFF” disappears, and the
SLEEP indicator goes off.
y
The sleep timer setting can also be canceled by pressing
STANDBY on the remote control (or STANDBY/ON on the front
panel) to set this unit to the standby mode.
ADVANCED OPERATIONS
Using the sleep timer
TRANSMITCODE SET
STANDBY
SYSTEM
POWER
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-AU X
DVD
AMP
POWERPOWER
VOLUME
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
AVTV
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
2
SLEEP
SLEEP 90min
SLEEP 60minSLEEP 30minSLEEP OFF
SLEEP 120min
CDTUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
96
24
q
PL
q
EX
MATRIX DISCRETE
SILENT CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO MUTE
VOLUME
MEMORY
SLEEP
VIRTUAL
PCM
q
PL
q
PL x
A B
SP
ft
mS
dB
dB
96/24
LFE
L C R
SL SB SR
q
DIGITAL
t
E1 SLEEP8 120minz
CDTUNER
MD/CD-R
DVD
HiFi DSP
DTV/CBL
V-AUXVCR
96
24
q
PL
q
EX
MATRIX DISCRETE
SILENT CINEMA NIGHT
ZONE2
PTY HOLD AUTO
PS RT CT EONPTY
TUNED STEREO MUTE
VOLUME
MEMORY
SLEEP
VIRTUAL
PCM
q
PL
q
PL x
A B
SP
ft
mS
dB
dB
96/24
LFE
L C R
SL SB SR
q
DIGITAL
t
E1 CONCERT2 HALLz
SLEEP indicator
SLEEP
SLEEP OFF
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 43 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
44
ADVANCED OPERATIONS
You can adjust the output level of each speaker while
listening to a music source. This is also possible when
playing sources through the MULTI CH INPUT jacks.
Please note that this operation will override the level
adjustments made in “BASIC SETUP” (page 23), “SP
LEVEL” (page 48) and “Using the test tone” (page 44).
1 Press AMP.
2 Press LEVEL repeatedly to select the
speaker you want to adjust.
FRONT L Front left speaker level
CENTER Center speaker level
FRONT R Front right speaker level
SUR.R Surround right speaker level
SUR.B Surround back speaker level
SUR.L Surround left speaker level
SWFR Subwoofer level
y
Once you press LEVEL, you can also select the speaker by
pressing u / d.
3 Press j / i to adjust the speaker output level.
The control range is from +10 dB to –10 dB.
4 Press SELECT when you have completed
your adjustment.
y
This operation can also be performed using the controls on the
front panel. Press
NEXT repeatedly to select the speaker you
want to adjust, then press LEVEL –/+ to adjust the output level.
You can use the test tone feature to manually balance your
speaker levels. Please note that this operation will override
the level adjustments made in “BASIC SETUP” (page 23),
“SP LEVEL” (page 48) and “Manually adjusting speaker
levels” (page 44). Use the test tone to set speaker levels so
that the volume from each speaker is identical when heard
from your listening position.
You cannot activate the test tone if headphones are connected to
the PHONES jack. Remove the headphones from the PHONES
ja
ck.
1 Press AMP.
2 Press TEST.
The unit outputs a test tone.
3 Press u / d repeatedly to select the speaker
you want to adjust.
TEST LEFT Front left speaker
TEST CENTER Center speaker
TEST RIGHT Front right speaker
TEST SUR.R Right surround speaker
TEST SUR.B Surround back speaker
TEST SUR.L Left surround speaker
TEST SUBWOOFER Subwoofer
4 Press j / i to adjust speaker volumes.
5 Press TEST when you have completed your
adjustment.
The test tone stops.
Manually adjusting speaker levels
AMP
REC
AUDIO
MUTE
MENUTITLE
VOLUME
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
VCR
PRESET/CH
SELECT
3
4
2
1
Using the test tone
Note
AMP
REC
AUDIO
MUTE
MENUTITLE
VOLUME
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHT
q
/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
SELECT
VCR
PRESET/CH
3,4
2,5
1
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 44 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
SET MENU
45
English
ADVANCED
OPERATION
You can use the following parameters in SET MENU to adjust a variety of system settings and customize the way this
unit operates. Change the initial settings (indicated in bold under each parameter) to reflect the needs of your listening
environment.
BASIC SETUP
Use to quickly setup basic system parameters (see page 23).
MANUAL SETUP
Use to adjust speaker and system settings.
1 SOUND MENU
Use to manually adjust any speaker setting, alter the quality and tone of the sound output by the system or compensate for
video signal processing delays when using LCD monitors or projectors.
y
Most of the parameters described in SOUND MENU are set automatically when you perform “BASIC SETUP” (see page 23). You can
use SOUND MENU to make further adjustmen
ts.
2 INPUT MENU
Use to reassign digital input/outputs and select the input mode.
3 OPTION MENU
Use to adjust the optional system parameters.
SET MENU
Item Features Page
A)SPEAKER SET
Selects the size of each speaker, the speakers for low-frequency signal output, and the cross over
frequency.
47
B)SP LEVEL
Adjusts the output level of each speaker.
48
C)SP DISTANCE
Adjusts the delay time of each speaker.
48
D)CENTER GEQ
Adjusts the tonal quality of the center speaker.
48
E)LFE LEVEL
Adjusts the output level of the LFE channel for Dolby Digital or DTS signals.
48
F)D. RANGE
Adjusts the dynamic range for Dolby Digital or DTS signals.
48
G)AUDIO SET
Customizes the muting level and audio delay.
49
Item Features Page
A)I/O ASSIGN
Assigns jacks according to the component to be used.
49
B)INPUT MODE
Selects the initial input mode of the source.
49
Item Features Page
A)DISPLAY SET
Adjusts the brightness of the display and converts video signals.
50
B)MEMORY GUARD
Locks sound field program parameters and other SET MENU settings.
50
C)PARAM. INI
Initializes the parameters of a group of sound field programs.
50
D)ZONE SET
Specifies the location of the speakers connected to the SPEAKERS B terminals.
50
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 45 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
46
SET MENU
Use the remote control to access and adjust each
parameter.
y
You can change SET MENU parameters while the unit is
reproducing sound.
You cannot change some SET MENU parameters while the unit
is in either cinema or music night listening mode.
1 Press AMP.
2 Press SET MENU.
“BASIC SETUP” appears in the front panel display.
3 Press u / d to display MANUAL SETUP.
MANUAL SETUP
4 Press SELECT to enter MANUAL SETUP.
1 SOUND MENU appears in the front panel display.
1 SOUND MENU
5 Press u / d to display the desired menu.
1 SOUND MENU
2 INPUT MENU
3 OPTION MENU
6 Press SELECT to enter the displayed menu.
Repeat steps 5 and 6 to navigate to and enter the items
you want to adjust.
To return to the previous menu level, press RETURN.
7 Press u / d to select the item you want to
adjust, then press j / i to change the setting
of the item.
Repeat this operation to select and adjust each setting.
To return to the previous menu level, press RETURN.
8 To exit, press SET MENU when finished.
Using SET MENU
Note
AMP
REC
AUDIO
MUTE
MENUTITLE
VOLUME
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHT
q
/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
SELECT
VCR
PRESET/CH
3-7
1
2,8
Memory back-up
The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data
from being lost even if this unit is in the standby mode.
However, if the power cord is disconnected from the
AC outlet, or the power supply is cut for more than one
week, the stored data will be lost. If so, adjust the
items again.
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 46 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
47
English
SET MENU
ADVANCED
OPERATION
Use to manually adjust any speaker setting or compensate
for video signal processing delays when using LCD
monitors or projectors. Most of the SOUND MENU
parameters are set automatically when you perform
“BASIC SETUP” (see page 23).
Speaker set A)SPEAKER SET
Use to manually adjust any speaker setting.
y
If you are not satisfied with the bass sounds from your speakers,
you can change these settings according to your preference.
Center speaker CENTER
Choices: LRG, SML, NONE
Select LRG if you have a large center speaker. The unit
directs the entire range of the center channel signal to
the center speaker.
Select SML if you have a small center speaker. The
unit directs the low-frequency signals of the center
channel to the speakers selected with “BASS OUT”.
Select NONE if you do not have a center speaker. The
unit directs all of the center channel signal to the front
left and right speakers.
Front speakers FRONT
Choices: LARGE, SMALL
Select LARGE if you have large front speakers. The
unit directs the entire range of the front left and right
channel signals to the front left and right speakers.
Select SMALL if you have small front speakers. The
unit directs the low-frequency signals of the front
channel to the speakers selected with “BASS OUT”.
Surround left/right speakers SURR LR
Choices: LRG, SML, NONE
Select LRG if you have large surround left and right
speakers. The entire range of the surround channel
signal is directed to the surround left and right
speakers.
Select SML if you have small surround left and right
speakers. The low-frequency signals of the surround
channel are directed to the speakers selected with
“BASS OUT”.
Select NONE if you do not have surround speakers.
This will set the unit to the Virtual CINEMA DSP
mode (see page 32) and automatically set the surround
back speaker setting (SURR.B) to NONE.
Surround back speaker SURR B
Choices: LRG, SML, NONE
Select LRG if you have a large surround back speaker.
Select SML if you have a small surround back speaker.
The low-frequency signals of the surround back
channel are directed to the speakers selected with
“BASS OUT”, and the rest of the frequency signals are
directed to the surround back speaker.
Select NONE if you do not have a surround back
speaker. The unit directs all of the surround back
channel signal to the surround left and right speakers.
Bass out BASS OUT
Low-frequency (bass) signals can be directed to the
subwoofer and/or the front left and right speakers
according to the characteristics of your system. This
setting also determines the routing of the LFE (low-
frequency effect) signals found in Dolby Digital or DTS
sources.
Choices: SWFR (subwoofer), FRONT, BOTH
Select SWFR if you connect a subwoofer. LFE and
low-frequency signals from other channels are directed
to the subwoofer according to the speaker settings.
Select FRONT if you do not use a subwoofer. LFE and
low-frequency signals from other channels are directed
to the front speakers according to the speaker settings
(even if you have previously set the front speakers to
SMALL).
Select BOTH if you connect a subwoofer and you want
to output low-frequency signals from front channels to
both the front speakers and subwoofer. LFE and low-
frequency signals from other channels are also directed
to the subwoofer according to the speaker settings. Use
this function to reinforce low-frequency signals using
the subwoofer when playing back sources such as CDs.
Cross over CrossOver
Use this feature to select a cross-over (cut-off) frequency
for all low-frequency signals. All frequencies below the
selected frequency will be sent to the subwoofer.
Choices: 40Hz, 60Hz, 80Hz, 90Hz, 100Hz, 110Hz,
120Hz, 160Hz, 200Hz
Subwoofer phase SWFR PHASE
If bass sounds are lacking or unclear, use this feature to
switch the phase of your subwoofer.
Choices: NRM (normal), REV (reverse)
Select NRM if you do not want to reverse the phase of
your subwoofer.
Select REV to reverse the phase of your subwoofer.
1 SOUND MENU
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 47 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
48
SET MENU
Speaker level B)SP LEVEL
Use these settings to manually balance the speaker levels
between the front left or surround left speakers and each
speaker selected in SPEAKER SET (page 47).
Choices: –10.0 dB to +10.0 dB
FR adjusts the balance of the front left and front right
speakers.
C adjusts the balance of the front left and center
speakers.
SL adjusts the balance of the front left and surround
left speakers.
SB adjusts the balance of the surround left and
surround back speakers.
SR adjusts the balance of the surround left and
surround right speakers.
SWFR adjusts the balance of the front left speaker and
subwoofer.
y
To calibrate, use the test tone feature (see page 44).
Speaker distance C)SP DISTANCE
Use this feature to manually input the distance of each
speaker and adjust the delay applied to respective channel.
Ideally, each speaker should be the same distance from the
main listening position. However, this is not possible in
most home situations. Thus, a certain amount of delay
must be applied to the sound from each speaker so that all
sound will arrive at the listening position at the same time.
Unit UNIT
Choices: meters (m), feet (ft)
Initial setting:
U.S.A. and Canada models: feet (ft)
Other models: meters (m)
Select meters to input speaker distances in meters.
Select feet to input speaker distances in feet.
Speaker distances
Choices: 0.3 to 24.00 m (1 to 80 ft)
FRONT L adjusts the distance of the front left speaker.
Initial setting: 3.0 m (10.0 ft)
FRONT R adjusts the distance of the front right
speaker. Initial setting: 3.0 m (10.0 ft)
CENTER adjusts the distance of the center speaker.
Initial setting: 3.0 m (10.0 ft)
SURR L adjusts the distance of the surround left
speaker. Initial setting: 3.0 m (10.0 ft)
SURR R adjusts the distance of the surround right
speaker. Initial setting: 3.0 m (10.0 ft)
SURR B adjusts the distance of the surround back
speaker. Initial setting: 2.10 m (7.0 ft)
SWFR adjusts the distance of the subwoofer. Initial
setting: 3.0 m (10.0 ft)
Center graphic equalizer D)CENTER GEQ
Use this feature to adjust the built-in 5-band graphic
equalizer for the center channel so that the tonal quality of
the center speaker matches that of the left and right main
speakers. You can make adjustments listening to the
currently selected source component or a test tone.
You can adjust 5 frequency bands:
100Hz, 300Hz, 1kHz, 3kHz, 10kHz
Choices: –6 to +6 dB
Select ON to output test tones from the front left and
center speakers, and adjust the tonal quality of the
center speaker.
Select OFF to stop the test tone and output the
currently selected source component.
Low-frequency effect level E)LFE LEVEL
Use to adjust the output level of the LFE (low-frequency
effect) channel according to the capacity of your
subwoofer or headphones. The LFE channel carries low-
frequency special effects which are only added to certain
scenes. This setting is effective only when this unit
decodes Dolby Digital or DTS signals.
Choices: –20 to 0 dB
Speaker SP LFE
Select to adjust the speaker LFE level.
Headphone HP LFE
Select to adjust the headphone LFE level.
Depending on the “LFE LEVEL” setting, some signals may not
be output from the SUB WOOFER OUTPUT jack.
Dynamic range F)D. RANGE
Use to select the amount of dynamic range compression to
be applied to your speakers or headphones. This setting is
effective only when the unit is decoding Dolby Digital and
DTS signals.
Choices: MAX (maximum), STD (standard), MIN
(minimum)
Speaker SP D.R
Select to adjust the speaker compression.
Headphone HP D.R
Select to adjust the headphone compression.
Select MAX for feature films.
Select STD for general use.
Select MIN for listening to sources at low volume
levels.
Note
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 48 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
49
English
SET MENU
ADVANCED
OPERATION
Audio set G)AUDIO SET
Use to customize this units overall audio settings.
Audio mute A.MUTE
Use to adjust how much the mute function reduces the
output volume.
Choices: MUTE, –20 dB
Select MUTE to completely halt all output of sound.
Select –20 dB to reduce the current volume by 20 dB.
Audio delay A.DELAY
Use to delay the sound output and synchronize it with the
video image. This may be necessary when using certain
LCD monitors or projectors.
Choices: 0 to 160 mS
Use to reassign digital input/outputs and select the input
mode.
Input/output assignment A)I/O ASSIGN
You can assign jacks according to the component to be
used if this unit’s initial settings do not correspond to your
needs. Change the following parameters to reassign the
respective jacks and effectively connect more components.
Once the inputs have been reassigned, you can select the
corresponding component by using INPUT on the front
panel or the input selector buttons on the remote control.
For COMPONENT VIDEO jacks A (C.V[A]) and B
(C.V[B])
Choices: DVD, V-AUX, DTV/CBL, VCR
For OPTICAL OUTPUT jack 1 (OUT(1))
Choices: MD/CD-R, CD, V-AUX, DTV/CBL, VCR, DVD
For OPTICAL INPUT jacks 2 (IN(2)), 3 (IN(3))
and 4 (IN(4))
Choices: CD, V-AUX, DTV/CBL, VCR, DVD,
MD/CD-R
For COAXIAL INPUT jack 5 (IN(5))
Choices: CD, V-AUX, DTV/CBL, VCR, DVD, MD/CD-R
You cannot select a specific item more than once for the same
type of jack.
When you connect a component to both the COAXIAL and
OPTICAL jacks, priority is given to the input signals from the
COAXIAL jack.
Input mode B)INPUT MODE
Use this feature to designate the input mode for sources
connected to the DIGITAL INPUT jacks when you turn on
this unit (see page 32 for details about the input mode).
Choices: AUTO, LAST
Select AUTO to allow this unit to automatically detect
the type of input signal and select the appropriate input
mode.
Select LAST to set this unit to automatically select the
last input mode used for that source.
Even if LAST is selected, the last setting for the EX/ES button
will not be recalled.
2 INPUT MENU
Notes
Note
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 49 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
50
SET MENU
Use to adjust the optional system parameters.
Display set A)DISPLAY SET
Dimmer DIMMER
Use to adjust the brightness of the front panel display.
Choices: –4 to 0
Video conversion V CONV.
Use this feature to turn on/off conversion of composite
(VIDEO) signals to S-Video signals. This allows you to
output converted video signals from the S VIDEO jacks
when no S-Video signals are input.
Choices: ON, OFF
Select OFF not to convert any signals.
Select ON to convert composite signals to S-Video
signals.
Converted video signals are only output to the MONITOR OUT
jacks. When recording you must make the same type of video
connections (i.e., S-Video) between each component.
Memory guard B)MEMORY GUARD
Use this feature to prevent accidental changes to DSP
program parameter values and other system settings.
Choices: ON, OFF
Select ON to protect:
DSP program parameters
All SET MENU items
All speaker levels
When “MEMORY GUARD” is set to ON, you cannot use
the test tone or select any other SET MENU items.
Parameter initialization C)PARAM. INI
Use this feature to initialize the parameters for each sound
field
program within a sound field program group. When
you initialize a sound
field program group, all of the
parameter values within that group revert to their initial
settings.
Press the corresponding numeric button for the sound
field
program that you want to initialize.
An asterisk (*) next to a program number means that the
parameter values have been changed from their initial
settings.
You cannot automatically revert to the previous parameter
settings once you initialize a
sound field program group.
You cannot separately initialize individual
sound field
programs.
You cannot initialize any program groups when “MEMORY
GUARD” is set to ON.
Zone set D)ZONE SET
Use to specify the location of speakers connected to the
SPEAKERS B terminals.
Speaker B set SP B
Use this feature to select the location of the front speakers
connected to the SPEAKERS B terminals.
Choices: FRONT, ZONE B
Select FRONT to turn on/off SPEAKERS A and B
when the speakers connected to the SPEAKERS B
terminals are set in the main room.
Select ZONE B if the speakers connected to the
SPEAKERS B terminals are set in another room. If
SPEAKERS A is turned OFF and SPEAKERS B is
turned ON, all the speakers including the subwoofer in
the main room are muted and the unit outputs sound
from SPEAKERS B only.
If you connect headphones to the PHONES jack on the unit
when “SP B” is set to ZONE B, the sound is output from both
headphones and SPEAKERS B.
If a DSP program is selected when “SP B” is set to ZONE B,
the unit automatically enters the Virtual CINEMA DSP mode.
3 OPTION MENU
Note
Notes
Notes
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 50 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
51
English
ADVANCED
OPERATION
In addition to controlling this unit, the remote control can also operate other A/V components made by YAMAHA and
other manufacturers. To control other components, you must set up remote control with the appropriate manufacturer
codes.
Controlling this unit
The shaded areas below can be used to control this unit
when the AMP mode is selected. Press AMP to activate
the AMP mode.
Controlling other components
The shaded areas below can be used to control other
components. Each button has a different function
depending on the selected components. Select the
component you want to control by pressing an input
selector button.
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
Control area
TRANSMITCODE SET
STANDBY
SYSTEM
POWER
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-A UX
DVD
AMP
POWERPOWER
REC
AUDIO
MUTE
MENUTITLE
VOLUME
DISC SKIP
FREQ/RDS
EONSTART
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
MODE PTY SEEK
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
AVTV
SELECT
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
PRESET/CH
The buttons in the
dotted lines
(SYSTEM
POWER,
STANDBY,
SLEEP, MULTI CH
IN, VOLUME +/–
and MUTE)
function in any
mode.
Press AMP to
control this unit.
TRANSMITCODE SET
STANDBY
SYSTEM
POWER
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-A UX
DVD
AMP
POWERPOWER
REC
AUDIO
MUTE
MENUTITLE
VOLUME
DISC SKIP
FREQ/RDS
EONSTART
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
MODE PTY SEEK
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
AVTV
SELECT
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
PRESET/CH
REC
AUDIO
MENUTITLE
DISC SKIP
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
SELECT
PRESET/CH
REC
AUDIO
MENUTITLE
DISC SKIP
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
SELECT
PRESET/CH
REC
AUDIO
MENUTITLE
DISC SKIP
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
SELECT
PRESET/CH
REC
AUDIO
MENUTITLE
DISC SKIP
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
SELECT
PRESET/CH
REC
AUDIO
MENUTITLE
DISC SKIP
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
SELECT
PRESET/CH
REC
AUDIO
MENUTITLE
DISC SKIP
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
SELECT
PRESET/CH
REC
AUDIO
MENUTITLE
DISC SKIP
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
SELECT
PRESET/CH
REC
AUDIO
MENUTITLE
DISC SKIP
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
SELECT
PRESET/CH
REC
AUDIO
MENUTITLE
DISC SKIP
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
SELECT
PRESET/CH
REC
AUDIO
MENUTITLE
DISC SKIP
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
SELECT
PRESET/CH
REC
AUDIO
MENUTITLE
DISC SKIP
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
SELECT
PRESET/CH
FREQ/RDS
EONSTARTMODE PTY SEEK
/ buttons and the
input selector buttons switch
the function of the
component control area
below.
*
Use the / buttons to
control other components
regardless of whether they
are connected to this unit.
Component control
area
You can control up to 9
different components by
setting appropriate
manufacturer codes (see
page 52).
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 51 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
52
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
You can control other components by setting the
appropriate manufacturer codes. Codes can be set up for
each input area. For a complete list of available
manufacturer codes, refer to “LIST OF
MANUFACTURER CODES” at the end of this manual.
The following table shows the factory preset component
(Library: component category) and the manufacturer code
for each area.
*1
U.K. and Europe models
*2
Other models
You may not be able to operate your YAMAHA component even
if a YAMAHA manufacturer code is initially set as listed above.
In this case, try to set other YAMAHA manufacturer code(s).
1 Press an input selector button or / to
select the component you want to set up.
2 Press CODE SET using a ballpoint pen or
similar object.
The TRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice.
3 Press the numeric buttons to enter the four
digit manufacturer’s code for the component
to be used.
Refer to “LIST OF MANUFACTURER CODES” at
the end of this manual.
The TRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice.
If the manufacturer of your component has more than one code,
try each of them until you find the correct one.
If you wait for more than 30 seconds during step 3, the setup
process is canceled. If this happens, start over from step 2.
Setting manufacturer codes
Input
area
Component
category
(Library)
Manufacturer Code
CD CD YAMAHA 0005
MD/CD-R MD YAMAHA 0024
TUNER TUNER YAMAHA
0023
*1
0003
*2
DVD DVD YAMAHA 0098
DTV/CBL
V-AU X
VCR
––
––
Note
Notes
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-AUX
DVD
AMP
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
TRANSMIT
CODE SET
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 52 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
53
English
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
ADVANCED
OPERATION
Once you set the appropriate manufacturer codes, you can
use this remote to control your other components. Note
that some buttons may not correctly operate the selected
component. Use the input selector buttons to select the
component you want to operate. The remote control
automatically switches to the appropriate control mode for
that component.
*1
This button functions only when the original remote control of the component has a POWER button.
*2
These buttons can operate your TV without switching the input if the manufacturer code is set in DTV/CBL or .
When the manufacturer code for your TV is set up in both the DTV/CBL and areas, priority is given to the signal in the DTV/
CBL area.
*3
These buttons can operate your VCR without switching the input to VCR if the manufacturer code is set in VCR.
Controlling other components
TRANSMITCODE SET
STANDBY
SYSTEM
POWER
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-A UX
DVD
AMP
POWERPOWER
MUTE
VOLUME
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
AVTV
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
REC
AUDIO
MENUTITLE
DISC SKIP
FREQ/RDS
EONSTART
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
MODE PTY SEEK
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHTq/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
SELECT
PRESET/CH
4
3
2
5
6
7
8
9
B
D
0
1
A
C
DVD player/
DVD recorder
VCR
Digital TV/
Cable TV
CD player MD/CD recorder Tuner
1 AV P OW ER
Power *1 Power *1 VCR power *3 Power *1 Power *1 Power *1
2 TV POWER
TV power *2 TV power *2 TV power TV power *2 TV power *2 TV power *2
3 TV CH +
TV channel up *2 TV channel up *2 TV channel up TV channel up *2 TV channel up *2 TV channel up *2
TV CH – TV channel down *2 TV channel down *2 TV channel down TV channel down *2 TV channel down *2 TV channel down *2
4 TV VOL +
TV volume up *2 TV volume up *2 TV volume up TV volume up *2 TV volume up *2 TV volume up *2
TV VOL – TV volume down *2 TV volume down *2 TV volume down TV volume down *2 TV volume down *2 TV volume down *2
5 TV MUTE
TV mute *2 TV mute *2 TV mute TV mute *2 TV mute *2 TV mute *2
6 TV INPUT
TV input *2 TV input *2 TV input TV input *2 TV input *2 TV input *2
7 1-9, 0, +10
Numeric buttons Numeric buttons Numeric buttons Numeric buttons Numeric buttons Preset stations (1-8)
8 TITLE
Title
9 PRESET/CH u
Up VCR channel up Preset up
PRESET/CH d Down VCR channel down Preset down
PRESET/CH j Right
PRESET/CH i Left
0 RETURN
Return
A REC/DISC
SKIP
Disc skip (player)
Rec (recorder)
Rec VCR rec *3 Rec (MD)
p Play Play VCR play *3 Play Play
w Search backward Search backward
VCR search
backward *3
Search backward Search backward
f Search forward Search forward VCR search forward *3 Search forward Search forward
AUDIO Audio
e Pause Pause VCR pause *3 Pause Pause
b Skip backward Skip backward Skip backward
a Skip forward Skip forward Skip forward
s Stop Stop VCR stop *3 Stop Stop
B ENTER
Title/Index Enter Enter Index Index
C MENU
Menu A/B/C/D/E
D DISPLAY
Display Display Display Display
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 53 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
54
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
Clearing a setup manufacturer code for
component control
1 Press an input selector button or / to
select the component control for which you
want to clear the manufacturer code.
2 Press CODE SET using a ballpoint pen or
similar object.
The TRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice.
3 If you do not press any button within 30
seconds after step 2, the clearing process is
canceled. If this happens, start over from
step 1.
4 Enter the code number “0000”.
The TRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice, and the manufacturer code for the
selected component is cleared.
y
You can clear all setup manufacturer codes at once by entering the
code number “9990”.
Clearing setup manufacturer codes
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-AUX
DVD
AMP
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
TRANSMIT
CODE SET
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 54 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
ZONE 2 (U.S.A., CANADA AND AUSTRALIA MODELS ONLY)
55
English
ADVANCED
OPERATION
This unit allows you to configure a multi-room audio system. You can control this unit from the second room using the
supplied remote control.
You need the following additional equipment to use the multi-room functions of this unit:
An infrared signal receiver in the second room.
An infrared emitter in the main room. This emitter transmits the infrared signals from the remote control in the second
room to the main room (to a CD player, for example).
An amplifier and speakers for the second room.
y
Since there are many possible ways to connect and use this unit in a multi-room installation, we recommend that you consult with the
nearest authorized YAMAHA dealer or service center for the Zone 2 connections which will best meet your requirements.
Some YAMAHA models are able to connect directly to the REMOTE CONTROL OUT jack of this unit. If you own these products,
you may not need to use an infrared emitter. Up to 6 YAMAHA components can be connected as shown.
System configuration and connections example
When not using the main room, turn down the volume of this unit in the main room. Adjust the ZONE 2 volume using the amplifier in
the second room.
To avoid unexpected noise, DO NOT USE the Zone 2 feature with CDs encoded in DTS.
ZONE 2
(U.S.A., CANADA AND AUSTRALIA MODELS ONLY)
Only analog signals are sent to the second room. Any source you want to listen to in the second room must be
connected using the analog (AUDIO L/R) input jacks on this unit.
Zone 2 connections
Notes
OUT
IN
OUT
IN
REMOTE
CONTROL OUT
This unit
REMOTE CONTROL OUT
DVD INPUT
ZONE 2 REMOTE IN
ZONE 2 OUTPUT
This unit
Infrared emitter
DVD player
(or other component)
Amplifier
Remote control
Infrared signal
receiver
Second room
Main room
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 55 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
56
ZONE 2 (U.S.A., CANADA AND AUSTRALIA MODELS ONLY)
The supplied remote control can be used to control Zone
2. You can even select the input source and control
components located in the main room directly from the
second room regardless of the listening condition in the
main room.
To enable Zone 2 mode on the remote
control
1 Press .
2 Press CODE SET using a ballpoint pen or
similar object.
The TRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
flashes twice.
3 Enter the code number “2999”.
Immediately after you have configured the remote
control for Zone 2, the remote will enter main mode.
When the remote is in main mode, you can turn the
main unit on, or set it in standby mode independently
of Zone 2 by pressing SYSTEM POWER or
STANDBY.
To control Zone 2
1 Press to set the remote control to Zone 2.
The TRANSMIT indicator on the remote control
lights up while the remote control is in Zone 2 mode.
2 Press SYSTEM POWER to turn Zone 2 power
on.
3 Press an input selector button to select the
input source you want to listen to in the
second room.
4 You can control Zone 2 using the input
selector buttons, STANDBY, SYSTEM
POWER and MUTE.
y
Zone 2 volume cannot be adjusted with the remote control. Use
the control on the amplifier in the second room.
The remote control returns to main mode 10 seconds after you
press , or if you press any button other than SYSTEM
POWER, STANDBY, MUTE or the input selector buttons. If the
TRANSMIT indicator is turned off, press to set the remote
control to Zone 2 mode before turning Zone 2 power on or off,
changing the input source, or muting the sound.
Remote controlling Zone 2
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-AUX
DVD
AMP
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
TRANSMIT
CODE SET
Note
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-AUX
DVD
AMP
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
TRANSMITCODE SET
STANDBY
SYSTEM
POWER
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-A UX
DVD
AMP
POWERPOWER
MUTE
VOLUME
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
AVTV
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 56 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
57
English
ZONE 2 (U.S.A., CANADA AND AUSTRALIA MODELS ONLY)
ADVANCED
OPERATION
When you have finished using the unit
To set both the main unit and Zone 2 to standby
mode
While holding down AMP, press STANDBY.
y
You can turn on both the main unit and Zone 2 simultaneously
by holding down AMP and pressing SYSTEM POWER.
SYSTEM POWER and STANDBY work differently depending
on the selected mode.
Special considerations for DTS software
The DTS signal is a digital bitstream. If you attempt to
send the DTS signal to the second room you will only hear
digital noise (that may damage your speakers). Thus, the
following considerations and adjustments need to be made
when playing DTS-encoded discs.
For DVDs encoded in DTS
Only 2 channel analog audio signals may be sent to the
second room.
Use the disc menu to set the DVD player’s mixed 2-
channel left and right audio outputs to the PCM or Dolby
Digital soundtrack.
For CDs encoded in DTS
To avoid unexpected noise, DO NOT USE the Zone 2
feature with CDs encoded in DTS.
TRANSMIT
indicator
SYSTEM POWER/
STANDBY
Main mode Off
Turns the main unit
on/standby
Zone 2 mode On
Turns Zone 2 to on/
standby
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 57 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
EDITING SOUND FIELD PARAMETERS
58
What really creates the rich, full tones of a live instrument
are the multiple reflections from the walls of the room. In
addition to making the sound “live”, these reflections
enable us to tell where the player is situated, and the size
and shape of the room in which we are sitting.
Elements of a sound field
In any environment, in addition to the direct sound coming
straight to our ears from the player’s instrument, there are
two distinct types of sound reflections that combine to
make up the sound field:
Early reflections
Reflected sounds reach our ears extremely rapidly (50 ms
– 100 ms after the direct sound), after reflecting from one
surface only — for example, from the ceiling or a wall.
Early reflections actually add clarity to the direct sound.
Reverberations
These are caused by reflections from more than one
surface — walls, ceiling, the back of the room — so
numerous that they merge together to form a continuous
sonic “afterglow”. They are non-directional, and lessen
the clarity of the direct sound.
Direct sound, early reflections and subsequent
reverberation taken together help us to determine the
subjective size and shape of the room, and it is this
information that the digital sound field processor
reproduces in order to create sound fields.
If you could create the appropriate early reflections and
subsequent reverberations in your listening room, you
would be able to create your own listening environment.
The acoustics in your room could be changed to those of a
concert hall, a dance floor, or virtually any size room at
all. This ability to create sound fields at will is exactly
what YAMAHA has done with the digital sound field
processor.
You can enjoy good quality sound with the factory preset
parameters. Although you do not have to change the initial
settings, you can change some of the parameters to better
suit the input source or your listening room.
1 Press AMP.
2 Select the sound field program you want to
adjust.
3 Press u / d to select
the parameters.
4 Press j / i to change
the parameter value.
EDITING SOUND FIELD PARAMETERS
What is a sound field Changing parameter settings
TRANSMITCODE SET
STANDBY
SYSTEM
POWER
CD
MD/CD-R
TUNER
V-AU X
DVD
AMP
POWERPOWER
VOLUME
TV MUTE TV INPUT
TV VOL TV CH
AVTV
VCR
DTV/CBL
MULTI CH IN
SLEEP
REC
AUDIO
MUTE
MENUTITLE
DISC SKIP
SET MENU
LEVEL
A/B/C/D/E
TEST
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHT
q
/DTS
EFFECT
DISPLAYRETURN
SELECT
PRESET/CH
3,4
1
2
AMP
STRAIGHT
ROCKJAZZHALLSTEREO
4321
8
10
7
09
65
ENTER
MOVIETV THTRMUSIC ENTERTAIN
EX/ESNIGHT
q
/DTS
EFFECT
SELECT
PRESET/CH
SELECT
PRESET/CH
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 58 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
59
English
EDITING SOUND FIELD PARAMETERS
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
5 Repeat steps 2 through 4 as necessary to
change other program parameters.
You cannot change parameter values when “MEMORY GUARD”
is set to ON. If you want to change the parameter values, set
“MEMORY GUARD” to OFF (see page 50).
Resetting parameters to the factory
presets
To reset a certain parameter
Select the parameter you want to reset, then press j / i
repeatedly to select the factory preset (the display pauses
momentarily at the factory preset before proceeding to the
next value).
To reset all parameters
Use PARAM. INI (see page 50).
Note
Memory back-up
The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data
from being lost even if this unit is set in the standby
mode, the power cord is disconnected from the AC
outlet, or the power supply is temporarily cut due to
power failure. However, if the power is cut for more
than one week, the parameter values will return to the
factory settings. If this happens, edit the parameter
value again.
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 59 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
SOUND FIELD PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS
60
You can adjust the values of certain digital sound field parameters so the sound fields are recreated accurately in your
listening room. Not all of the following parameters are found in every program.
DSP LEVEL
Function: This parameter adjusts the level of all the DSP effect sounds within a narrow range.
Description: Depending on the acoustics of your listening room, you may want to increase or decrease the DSP
effect level relative to the level of the direct sound.
Control range: –6 dB – +3 dB
DELAY (Delay)
Function: This parameter changes the apparent distance from the source sound by adjusting the delay between the
direct sound and the first reflection heard by the listener.
Description: The smaller the value, the closer the sound source seems to the listener. The larger the value, the farther
it seems. For a small room, set to a small value. For a large room, set to a large value.
Control range: 1
99 msec
For 6ch Stereo
Function: These parameter adjusts the volume level for each channel in 6-channel stereo mode.
Control Range: 0 – 100%
CT LEVEL (Center level)
SL LEVEL (Surround left level)
SR LEVEL (Surround right level)
SB LEVEL (Surround back level)
SOUND FIELD PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS
Source Sound
Early
Reflections
Time
Time
Time
DELAY
DELAY
DELAY
Sound Source
Reflection Face
Level
Small value = 1 ms Large value = 99 ms
Level
Level
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 60 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
61
English
SOUND FIELD PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
For PRO LOGIC IIx Music and PRO LOGIC II Music
PANORAMA
Function: Extends the front stereo image to include the surround speakers for wraparound effect.
Choices: OFF/ON, initial setting is OFF.
DIMENSION
Function: Gradually adjusts the sound field either towards the front or towards the rear.
Control range: –3 (towards the rear) to +3 (towards the front), initial setting is STD (standard).
CT WIDTH (Center width)
Function: Adjusts the center image from all three front speakers to varying degrees. A larger value adjusts the
center image towards the front left and right speakers.
Control range: 0 (center channel sound is output only from center speaker) to 7 (center channel sound is output only
from front left and right speakers), initial setting is 3.
For PRO LOGIC IIx Movie, Music and Game
PLII/PLIIx (Pro Logic II/Pro Logic IIx)
Function: Switches the type of Pro Logic decoding to be used. PLII decoding creates 5.1-channel sound from
2-channel sources. PLIIx decoding creates 6.1-channel sound from 2-channel sources.
Choices: PLII, PLIIx
For DTS Neo:6 Music
C. IMAGE (Center image)
Function: This parameter adjusts the center image from all three front speakers to varying degrees.
Control range: 0 – 0.5
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 61 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
TROUBLESHOOTING
62
Refer to the chart below when this unit does not function properly. If the problem you are experiencing is not listed below
or if the instruction below does not help, set this unit to the standby mode, disconnect the power cord, and contact the
nearest authorized YAMAHA dealer or service center.
General
TROUBLESHOOTING
Problem Cause Remedy
Refer to
page
This unit fails to turn
on when STANDBY/
ON (or SYSTEM
POWER) is pressed,
or enters in the
standby mode soon
after the power has
been turned on.
The power cord is not connected or the
plug is not completely inserted.
Connect the power cord firmly.
The impedance setting is incorrect. Set the impedance to match your speakers.
21
The protection circuitry has been
activated.
Make sure all speaker wire connections on this unit
and on all speakers are secure and that the wire for
each connection does not touch anything other than
its respective connection.
12-13
This unit has been exposed to a strong
external electric shock (such as lightning
and strong static electricity).
Set this unit in the standby mode, disconnect the
power cord, plug it back in after 30 seconds, then use
it normally.
No sound Incorrect input or output cable
connections.
Connect the cables properly. If the problem persists,
the cables may be defective.
15-18
The input mode is set to DTS or
ANALOG.
Select AUTO.
32
No appropriate input source has been
selected.
Select an appropriate input source with INPUT,
MULTI CH INPUT or the input selector buttons.
26
Speaker connections are not secure. Secure the connections.
12
The front speakers to be used have not
been selected properly.
Select the front speakers with SPEAKERS A and/or
B.
26
The volume is turned down. Turn up the volume.
The sound is muted. Press MUTE or any operation buttons of this unit to
cancel a mute and adjust the volume.
27
The input mode is set to ANALOG while
playing a source encoded with a DTS
signal.
Set the input mode to AUTO or DTS.
32
The signals this unit cannot reproduce are
being received from a source component
e.g.: a CD-ROM.
Play a source whose signals this unit can reproduce.
No picture The output and input for the picture are
connected to different types of video
jacks.
Turn on the video conversion function.
50
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 62 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
63
English
TROUBLESHOOTING
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
Problem Cause Remedy
Refer to
page
The sound suddenly
goes off.
The protection circuitry has been activated
because of a short circuit, etc.
Check that the impedance selector setting is correct.
21
Check that the speaker wires are not touching each
other and then turn this unit back on.
The sleep timer has turned the unit off. Turn on the power, and play the source again.
The sound is muted. Press MUTE to cancel a mute.
27
Only the speaker on
one side can be
heard.
Incorrect cable connections. Connect the cables properly. If the problem persists,
the cables may be defective.
12
Incorrect balance settings in SET MENU. Adjust the SP LEVEL settings.
48
Only the center
speaker outputs
substantial sound.
When playing a monaural source with a
CINEMA DSP program, the source signal
is directed to the center channel, and the
front and surround speakers output effect
sounds.
No sound from the
effect speakers.
The sound field programs are turned off. Press STRAIGHT (EFFECT) to turn them on.
32
You are using a source or program
combination that does not output sound
from all channels.
Try another sound field program.
28, 40
No sound from the
center speaker.
The output level of the center speaker is
set to minimum.
Raise the level of the center speaker.
48
“CENTER” in SET MENU is set to
NONE.
Select the appropriate setting for the center speaker.
47
One of the Hi-Fi DSP programs (except
for 6ch Stereo) has been selected.
Try another sound field program.
28, 40
No sound from the
surround speakers.
The output level of the surround speakers
is set to minimum.
Raise the output level of the surround speakers.
48
“SURR LR” in SET MENU is set to
NONE.
Select the appropriate setting for the surround left and
right speakers.
47
A monaural source is being played with
STRAIGHT.
Press STRAIGHT (EFFECT) to turn on the sound
fields.
No sound from the
surround back
speaker.
“SURR LR” in SET MENU is set to
NONE.
If the surround left and right speakers are set to
NONE, the surround back speaker setting is
automatically set to NONE. Select the appropriate
setting for the surround speakers.
47
“SURR B” in SET MENU is set to
NONE.
Select LRG or SML.
47
No sound from the
subwoofer.
“BASS OUT” in SET MENU is set to
FRONT when a Dolby Digital or DTS
signal is being played.
Select SWFR or BOTH.
47
“BASS OUT” in SET MENU is set to
SWFR or FRONT when a 2-channel
source is being played.
Select BOTH.
47
The source does not contain low bass
signals.
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 63 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
64
TROUBLESHOOTING
Problem Cause Remedy
Refer to
page
Dolby Digital or DTS
sources cannot be
played. (Dolby Digital
or DTS indicator in
the front panel
display does not light
up.)
The connected component is not set to
output Dolby Digital or DTS digital
signals.
Make an appropriate setting following the operations
instructions for your component.
The input mode is set to ANALOG. Set the input mode to AUTO or DTS.
32
A “humming” sound
can be heard.
Incorrect cable connections. Firmly connect the audio plugs. If the problem
persists, the cables may be defective.
The volume level
cannot be increased,
or the sound is
distorted.
The component connected to the OUT
(REC) jacks of this unit is turned off.
Turn on the power to the component.
The sound effect
cannot be recorded.
It is not possible to record the sound effect
with a recording component.
A source cannot be
recorded by a digital
recording component
connected to this
DIGITAL OUTPUT
jack.
The source component is not connected to
this units DIGITAL INPUT jacks.
Connect the source component to the DIGITAL
INPUT jacks.
14-18, 39
Some components cannot record the
Dolby Digital or DTS sources.
A source cannot be
recorded by an
analog component
connected to the
AUDIO OUT jacks.
The source component is not connected to
this units analog AUDIO IN jacks.
Connect the source component to the analog AUDIO
IN jacks.
14-18, 39
The sound field
parameters and some
other settings on this
unit cannot be
changed.
“MEMORY GUARD” in SET MENU is
set to ON.
Select OFF.
50
This unit does not
operate properly.
The internal microcomputer has been
frozen by an external electric shock (such
as lightning or excessive static electricity)
or by a power supply with low voltage.
Disconnect the AC power cord from the outlet and
then plug it in again after about 30 seconds.
“CHECK SP WIRES”
appears in the front
panel display.
Speaker cables are short circuited. Make sure all speaker cables are connected correctly.
12
There is noise
interference from
digital or high-
frequency equipment,
or this unit.
This unit is too close to the digital or high-
frequency equipment.
Move this unit further away from such equipment.
The picture is
disturbed.
The video source uses scrambled or
encoded signals to prevent dubbing.
This unit suddenly
turns into the standby
mode.
The internal temperature becomes too
high and the overheat protection circuitry
has been activated.
Wait about 1 hour for this unit to cool down and then
turn it back on.
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 64 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
65
English
TROUBLESHOOTING
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
Tuner
Remote control
Problem Cause Remedy
Refer
to page
FM
FM stereo reception is
noisy.
The characteristics of FM stereo
broadcasts may cause this problem
when the transmitter is too far away or
the antenna input is poor.
Check the antenna connections.
Try using a high-quality directional FM
antenna.
19
Use the manual tuning method.
35
There is distortion, and
clear reception cannot
be obtained even with a
good FM antenna.
There is multipath interference. Adjust the antenna position to eliminate
multipath interference.
The desired station
cannot be tuned in with
the automatic tuning
method.
The signal is too weak. Use a high-quality directional FM antenna.
19
Use the manual tuning method.
35
Previously preset
stations can no longer
be tuned in.
This unit has been disconnected for a
long period.
Preset the stations again.
35
AM
The desired station
cannot be tuned in with
the automatic tuning
method.
The signal is weak or the antenna
connections are loose.
Tighten the AM loop antenna connections
and orient it for best reception.
Use the manual tuning method.
35
There are continuous
crackling and hissing
noises.
Noises result from lightning,
fluorescent lamps, motors, thermostats
and other electrical equipment.
Use an outdoor antenna and a ground wire.
This will help somewhat, but it is difficult to
eliminate all noise.
There are buzzing and
whining noises.
A TV set is being used nearby. Move this unit away from the TV.
Problem Cause Remedy
Refer to
page
The remote control
does not work nor
function properly.
Wrong distance or angle. The remote control will function within a maximum
range of 6 m (20 ft) and no more than 30 degrees off-
axis from the front panel.
7
Direct sunlight or lighting (from an
inverter type of fluorescent lamp, etc.) is
striking the remote control sensor of this
unit.
Reposition this unit.
The batteries are weak. Replace all batteries.
3
The manufacturer code was not correctly
set.
Set the manufacturer code correctly using the “LIST
OF MANUFACTURER CODES” at the end of this
manual.
52
Try to set another code for the same manufacturer
using the “LIST OF MANUFACTURER CODES” at
the end of this manual.
52
Even if the manufacturer code is correctly
set, there are some models that do not
respond to the remote control.
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 65 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
RESETTING THE FACTORY PRESETS
66
If you want to reset all of your unit’s parameters for any
reason, do the following. This procedure completely resets
ALL parameters, including the SET MENU, level, assign
and tuner presets.
Be sure this unit is in standby mode.
1 Hold down STRAIGHT (EFFECT) on the front
panel and press STANDBY/ON.
“FACTORY PRESET” appears in the front panel
display.
y
To cancel the initialization procedure without making any
changes, press STANDBY/ON.
2 Press STRAIGHT (EFFECT) to select the
desired setting.
Reset To reset the unit to its factory presets.
Cancel To cancel without making any changes.
3 Press STANDBY/ON to confirm your
selection.
If you selected “Reset”, the unit is reset to its factory
presets and switches to standby mode.
If you selected “Cancel”, the unit switches to standby
mode and nothing is reset.
RESETTING THE FACTORY PRESETS
AUTO/MAN'L MONOMAN'L/AUTO FMLEVELNEXTEDIT
EFFECT
MEMORYFM/AMPRESET/TUNING
A/B/C/D/E
PROGRAM
l PRESET/TUNING h
TUNING MODE
INPUT MODETONE CONTROLSTRAIGHT
SPEAKERS
PHONES
SILENT CINEMA
BA
MULTI CH
INPUT
VOLUME
INPUT
VIDEO L AUDIO R
VIDEO AUX
STANDBY
/ON
STANDBY/ON
STRAIGHT (EFFECT)
(U.S.A. model)
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 66 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
GLOSSARY
67
English
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital is a digital surround sound system that gives
you completely independent multi-channel audio. With 3
front channels (left, center, and right), and 2 surround
stereo channels, Dolby Digital provides 5 full-range audio
channels. With an additional channel especially for bass
effects, called LFE (low frequency effect), the system has
a total of 5.1-channels (LFE is counted as 0.1 channel). By
using 2-channel stereo for the surround speakers, more
accurate moving sound effects and surround sound
environment are possible than with Dolby Surround. The
wide dynamic range (from maximum to minimum
volume) reproduced by the 5 full-range channels and the
precise sound orientation generated using digital sound
processing provide listeners with previously unheard of
excitement and realism.
With this unit, any sound environment from monaural up
to a 5.1-channel configuration can be freely selected for
your enjoyment.
Dolby Digital Surround EX
Dolby Digital EX creates 6 full-bandwidth output
channels from 5.1-channel sources. This is done using a
matrix decoder that derives 3 surround channels from the
2 in the original recording. For the best results, Dolby
Digital EX should be used with movie sound tracks
recorded with Dolby Digital Surround EX. With this
additional channel, you can experience more dynamic and
realistic moving sound especially with scenes with
“flyover” and “fly-around” effects.
Dolby Pro Logic II
Dolby Pro Logic II is an improved technique used to
decode vast numbers of existing Dolby Surround software.
This new technology enables a discrete 5-channel
playback with 2 front left and right channels, 1 center
channel, and 2 surround left and right channels (instead of
only 1 surround channel for conventional Pro Logic
technology). Music and Game modes are also available for
2-channel sources in addition to the Movie mode.
Dolby Pro Logic IIx
Dolby Pro Logic IIx is a new technology enabling discrete
multi-channel playback from 2-channel or multi-channel
sources. There is a Music mode for music, a Movie mode
for movies (for 2-channel sources only) and a Game mode
for games.
Dolby Surround
Dolby Surround uses a 4 channel analog recording system
to reproduce realistic and dynamic sound effects: 2 front
left and right channels (stereo), a center channel for dialog
(monaural), and a surround channel for special sound
effects (monaural). The surround channel reproduces
sound within a narrow frequency range.
Dolby Surround is widely used with nearly all video tapes
and laser discs, and in many TV and cable broadcasts as
well. The Dolby Pro Logic decoder built into this unit
employs a digital signal processing system that
automatically stabilizes the volume on each channel to
enhance moving sound effects and directionality.
DTS 96/24
DTS 96/24 offers an unprecedented level of audio quality
for multi-channel sound on DVD-Video, and is fully
backward-compatible with all DTS decoders. “96” refers
to a 96 kHz sampling rate (compared to the typical 48 kHz
sampling rate). “24” refers to 24-bit word length. DTS 96/
24 offers sound quality transparent to the original 96/24
master, and 96/24 5.1-channel sound with full-quality full-
motion video for music programs and motion picture
soundtracks on DVD-video.
DTS (Digital Theater Systems)
Digital Surround
DTS digital surround was developed to replace the analog
soundtracks of movies with a 6-channel digital sound
track, and is now rapidly gaining popularity in movie
theaters around the world. Digital Theater Systems Inc.
has developed a home theater system so that you can enjoy
the depth of sound and natural spatial representation of
DTS digital surround in your home. This system produces
practically distortion-free 6-channel sound (technically, a
left, right and center channels, 2 surround channels, plus
an LFE 0.1 channel as a subwoofer, for a total of 5.1-
channels). The unit incorporates a DTS-ES decoder that
enables 6.1- channel reproduction by adding the surround
back channel to existing 5.1-channel format.
Neo:6
Neo:6 decodes the conventional 2-channel sources for 6
channel playback by the specific decoder. It enables
playback with the full-range channels with higher
separation just like digital discrete signal playback. Two
modes are available; “Music mode” for playing music
sources and “Cinema mode” for movies.
GLOSSARY
Audio formats
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 67 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
68
GLOSSARY
CINEMA DSP
Since the Dolby Surround and DTS systems were
originally designed for use in movie theaters, their effect
is best felt in a theater having many speakers and designed
for acoustic effects. Since home conditions, such as room
size, wall material, number of speakers, and so on, can
differ so widely, it’s inevitable that there are differences in
the sound heard as well. Based on a wealth of actually
measured data, YAMAHA CINEMA DSP uses
YAMAHA original sound field technology to combine
Dolby Pro Logic, Dolby Digital and DTS systems to
provide the visual and audio experience of movie theater
in the listening room of your own home.
SILENT CINEMA
YAMAHA has developed a natural, realistic sound effect
DSP algorithm for headphones.
Parameters for headphones have been set for each sound
field so that accurate representations of all the sound field
programs can be enjoyed on headphones.
Virtual CINEMA DSP
YAMAHA has developed a Virtual CINEMA DSP
algorithm that allows you to enjoy DSP sound field
surround effects even without any surround speakers by
using virtual surround speakers.
It is even possible to enjoy Virtual CINEMA DSP using a
minimal two-speaker system that does not include a center
speaker.
ITU-R
ITU-R is the radio communication sector of the ITU
(International Telecommunication Union). ITU-R
recommends a standard speaker placement which is used
in many critical listening rooms, especially for mastering
purposes.
LFE 0.1 channel
This channel is for the reproduction of low bass signals.
The frequency range for this channel is 20 Hz to 120 Hz.
This channel is counted as 0.1 because it only enforces a
low frequency range compared to the full-range
reproduced by the other 5/6 channels in Dolby Digital or
DTS 5.1/6.1-channel systems.
PCM (Linear PCM)
Linear PCM is a signal format under which an analog
audio signal is digitized, recorded and transmitted without
using any compression. This is used as a method of
recording CDs and DVD audio. The PCM system uses a
technique for sampling the size of the analog signal per
very small unit of time. Standing for “pulse code
modulation”, the analog signal is encoded as pulses and
then modulated for recording.
Sampling frequency and number of
quantized bits
When digitizing an analog audio signal, the number of
times the signal is sampled per second is called the
sampling frequency, while the degree of fineness when
converting the sound level into a numeric value is called
the number of quantized bits.
The range of rates that can be played back is determined
based on the sampling rate, while the dynamic range
representing the sound level difference is determined by
the number of quantized bits. In principle, the higher the
sampling frequency, the wider the range of frequencies
that can be played back, and the higher the number of
quantized bits, the more finely the sound level can be
reproduced.
Sound field programs Audio information
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 68 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
69
English
GLOSSARY
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
Component video signal
With the component video signal system, the video signal
is separated into the Y signal for the luminance and the P
B
and PR signals for the chrominance. Color can be
reproduced more faithfully with this system because each
of these signals is independent. The component signal is
also called the “color difference signal” because the
luminance signal is subtracted from the color signal.
A monitor with component input jacks is required in order
to use the component signal for output.
Composite video signal
With the composite video signal system, the video signal
is composed of three basic elements of a video picture;
color, brightness and synchronization data. A composite
video jack on a video component transmits these three
elements combined.
S-Video signal
With the S-Video signal system, the video signal normally
transmitted using a pin cable is separated and transmitted
as the Y signal for the luminance and the C signal for the
chrominance through the S-Video cable. Using the S
VIDEO jack eliminates video signal transmission loss and
allows recording and playback of even more beautiful
images.
Video signal information
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 69 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
SPECIFICATIONS
70
AUDIO SECTION
Minimum RMS Output Power for Front, Center, Surround,
Surround back
20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.06% THD, 8 ....................................... 90 W
Maximum Power (EIAJ)
[China, Korea and General models]
1 kHz, 10% THD, 8 ......................................................... 130 W
Dynamic Power (IHF)
8/6/4/2 ....................................................... 120/155/190/235 W
DIN Standard Output Power [U.K., Europe and Asia models]
1 kHz, 0.7% THD, 4 ........................................................ 135 W
IEC Output Power [U.K., Europe and Asia models]
1 kHz, 0.06% THD, 8 ...................................................... 100 W
Damping Factor (IHF)
20 Hz to 20 kHz, 8 ...................................................100 or more
Frequency Response
CD terminal to Front L/R ...................... 10 Hz to 100 kHz, –3 dB
Total Harmonic Distortion
CD, etc. to Front L/R (20 Hz to 20 kHz, 40 W, 8 Ω)........... 0.06%
Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF-A Network)
CD (250 mV) to Front L/R, Effect Off ................................100 dB
Residual Noise (IHF-A Network)
Front L/R ................................................................ 150 µV or less
Channel Separation (1 kHz/10 kHz)
CD (5.1 k terminated) to Front L/R ....................... 60 dB/45 dB
Tone Control (Front L/R)
BASS Boost/Cut ...................................................... ±10 dB/60 Hz
TREBLE Boost/Cut .............................................. ±10 dB/20 kHz
Phones Output .......................................................... 150 mV/100
Input Sensitivity/Input Impedance
CD, etc. ................................................................. 200 mV/47 k
MULTI CH INPUT ............................................... 200 mV/47 k
Output Level/Output Impedance
REC OUT.............................................................. 200 mV/1.2 k
SUB WOOFER ........................................................... 4 V/1.2 k
ZONE 2 OUTPUT
[U.S.A., Canada and Australia models]............. 200 mV/1.2 k
VIDEO SECTION
Video Signal Type .......................................................... PAL/NTSC
Signal to Noise Ratio .............................................................. 50 dB
Frequency Response (MONITOR OUT)
Composite, S-Video ................................. 5 Hz to 10 MHz, –3 dB
Component .............................................. 5 Hz to 60 MHz, –3 dB
FM SECTION
Tuning Range
[U.S.A. and Canada models] .......................... 87.5 to 107.9 MHz
[Asia and General model] ......... 87.5/87.50 to 108.0/108.00 MHz
[Other models] ............................................ 87.50 to 108.00 MHz
Usable Sensitivity (IHF)....................................... 1.0 µV (11.2 dBf)
Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF)
Mono/Stereo ............................................................. 76 dB/70 dB
Harmonic Distortion (1 kHz)
Mono/Stereo ................................................................ 0.2%/0.3%
Stereo Separation (1 kHz) ....................................................... 42 dB
Frequency Response ......................... 20 Hz to 15 kHz, +0.5, –2 dB
AM SECTION
Tuning Range
[U.S.A. and Canada models] .............................. 530 to 1710 kHz
[Asia and General models] ................. 530/531 to 1710/1611 kHz
[Other models] .................................................... 531 to 1611 kHz
Usable Sensitivity ............................................................. 300 µV/m
GENERAL
Power Supply
[U.S.A. and Canada models] ............................. AC 120 V, 60 Hz
[Australia model] ............................................... AC 240 V, 50 Hz
[China model] .................................................... AC 220 V, 50 Hz
[Korea model] .................................................... AC 220 V, 60 Hz
[U.K. and Europe models] ................................. AC 230 V, 50 Hz
[General model] ................ AC 110/120/220/230-240 V, 50/60 Hz
[Asia model] ....................................AC 220/230-240 V, 50/60 Hz
Power Consumption
[U.S.A. and Canada models] ................................. 350 W/440 VA
[Other models] .................................................................... 360 W
Standby Power Consumption ................................................. 0.1 W
AC Outlets
[U.K. and Australia models] ............... 1 (Total 100 W maximum)
[Asia and General models] ................... 2 (Total 50 W maximum)
[Other models] ..................................... 2 (Total 100 W maximum)
Dimension (W x H x D) ................................... 435 x 171 x 420 mm
(17-1/8” x 6-3/4” x 16-1/2”)
Weight ................................................................. 11 kg (24 lbs 4 oz)
SPECIFICATIONS
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 70 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
i
LIST OF MANUFACTURER CODES
TV
A TANDY 0941
ABEX 1151
ADMIRA 1141
ADVENTURA 1131
AIKO 1121
AIWA 1481
AKAI 0331, 1101, 1111
ALBA 0431
ALLERON 1091
AMBASSADOR 1081
AMSTRAD 0481, 1081
ANAM 0251, 1041, 1051,
1061, 1071
ANAM NATIONAL 1041
AOC 0361, 1021, 1031,
1111, 1161
ARCHER 1161
AUDIOSONIC 1001
AUDIOVOX 1051, 1161
BAUER 0441
BAUR 1001
BEIJING 1511, 1551, 1561
BELCOR 1031
BELL & HOWELL 0981, 0991
BEON 1001
BRADFORD 1051
BROCKWOOD 1031
BROKSONIC 1161
BUSH 1001
CANDLE 0351, 0361, 0961,
0971, 1111, 1131
CAPEHART 1021
CARVER 0101
CATHAY 1001
CELEBRITY 0951
CENTURION 0411
CHANGHONG 1541, 1551, 1561,
1621
CITIZEN 0351, 0361, 0921,
0931, 0941, 0961,
0971, 1111, 1121,
1131
CLAIRTONE 1011
CLARIVOX 1001
CONCERTO 0351, 0971
CONROWA 1751
CONTEC 0901, 0911, 1011,
1051
CORANDO 0941
CRAIG 0251, 1051
CROWN 0941, 1051
CURTIS MATHES 0161, 0361,
0931, 0941,
0981, 1111
CXC 1051
DAEWOO 0291, 0301, 0331,
0721, 0941, 1001,
1031, 1121, 1191,
1531, 1581, 1591,
1601
DANSAI 1001
DAYTRON 0941, 1031
DECCA 0271, 1001
DIXI 0331, 1001, 1071
DUMONT 0891, 1031
DYNATECH 0881
ELECTROBAND 0951, 1011
ELECTROHOME 0941
ELECTRON 0941
ELIN 1001
ELTA 0331
EMERSON 0001, 0021, 0061,
0071, 0081, 0091,
0111, 0811, 0821,
0831, 0841, 0851,
0861, 0871, 0901,
0921, 0941, 0981,
1011, 1031, 1051,
1081, 1091
ENVISION 0361, 1111
ERRES 1001
ETRON 0331
FERGUSON 1001
FINLUX 1001
FISHER 0171, 0801, 0981
FORMENTI 0441
FORMONTI 1001
FORTRESS 1141
FUJITSU 1091
FUNAI 1051, 1091, 1501,
1521
FUTURETECH 1051
GE 0131, 0161, 0201,
0751, 0761, 0771,
0781, 0791, 0811,
0861, 1041
GEC 0271, 1001
GEMINI 0391
GENEXXA 0431
GIBRALTER 0891, 1031, 1111
GOODMANS/TASHIKO
0271, 0661, 1001
GRANADA 1001
GRUNDIG 1781, 1791, 1801,
1811, 1821, 1831,
1841, 1851, 1861,
1871, 1881
GUNPY 1051, 1091
HARMAN/KARDON 0721
HALLMARK 0861
HANSEATIC 1001
HARVARD 1051, 1061
HINARI 1001, 1091
HITACHI 0181, 0351, 0671,
0681, 0691, 0701,
0711, 0871, 0941,
0971, 1351
HYPSON 1001
IMA 1051
INDIANA 1001
INFINITY REFERENCE
0101
INTERFUNK 1001
ITT 0611
JANEIL 1131
JBL 0101
JCB 0951
JENSEN 0311
JINXING 1531, 1541, 1551,
1561, 1571, 1621,
1631, 1641, 1651,
1691, 1731
JVC (VICTOR) 0261, 0281, 0641,
0651, 0661, 0841
KAWASHO 0901
KAYPANI 1021
KENWOOD 0361, 1031, 1111
KLOSS 0631, 0721, 1131
KTV 0921, 0941, 1011,
1051, 1111
LEYCO 1001
LG (GOLDSTAR) 0031, 0121,
0351, 0411, 0731,
0741, 0861, 0941,
0971, 1001, 1031,
1111, 1151
LIESENK & TTER 1001
LLOYTRON 0941
LOEWE 1001
LOGIK 0991, 1771
LUXMAN 0351, 0971
LXI 0101, 0621, 0761,
0861, 0981
MAGNAVOX 0101, 0341, 0391,
0401, 0411, 0421,
0581, 0591, 0601,
0611, 0631, 0661,
0961, 1111
MAJESTIC 0991
MARANTZ 0101, 0221, 0361,
1001, 1111
MARK 1001
MATSUI 0271, 0331, 1001
MEDIATOR 1001
MEGATRON 0691, 0861, 1161
MEI 1011
M-ELECTRONIC 1001
MEMOREX 0331, 0571, 0861,
0971, 0981, 0991,
1771
METZ 1791, 1831, 1891,
1901, 1911, 1921,
1931, 1941
MGA 0361, 0561, 0571,
0861, 1031, 1111
MIDLAND 0751, 0761, 0891,
0941, 1151
MITSUBISHI 0221, 0321, 0561,
0571, 0661, 0861,
1031, 1101, 1381
MONTGOMERY 1091
MOTOROLA 1041, 1141
MTC 0351, 0361, 0881,
0931, 0971, 1011,
1031, 1111
MULTITECH 0881, 1051
NAD 0551, 0621, 0861
NEC 0241, 0351, 0361,
0661, 0971, 1031,
1111, 1321, 1711
NECKERMANN 1001
NEI 1001
NIKKAI 0271, 0431, 1001,
1151
NIKKO 0861, 1111, 1121
NOVABEAM 0721
NTC 1121
ONWA 1051
OPTIMUS 0551
OPTONICA 0541, 1141
ORION 0831, 1001
OSAKI 0271, 1151
OTTO VERSAND 1001
PANASONIC 0101, 0191, 0251,
0751, 1041, 1311,
1371, 1431
PANDA 1541, 1721
PENNY 0161, 0361, 0521,
0531, 0621, 0731,
0751, 0761, 0781,
0791, 0861, 0931,
0941, 1031, 1041,
1111, 1151, 1161
PEONY 1561, 1621
PHILCO 0361, 0581, 0591,
0601, 0611, 0631,
0961, 1031, 1111
PHILIPS 0101, 0401, 1001
PHONOLA 1001
PILOT 0941, 1031, 1111
PIONEER 0511, 0551, 0871
PORTLAND 0941, 1031, 1121
PRICECLUB 0931
PRISM 0751
PROSCAN 0761
PROTECH 1001
PROTON 0501, 0861, 0941,
1021, 1161
PULSAR 0891
PULSER 1031
QUASAR 0251, 0751, 1041
QUELLE 1001
RADIO SHACK 0541, 0941,
1031, 1051,
1151
RADIOLA 1001
RCA 0051, 0141, 0151,
0181, 0411, 0491,
0531, 0761, 0771,
0871, 1031
REALISTIC 0541, 0861, 0941,
0971, 0981, 1031,
1051, 1111, 1151
RHAPSODY 1011
R-LINE 1001
RUNCO 0891, 1111
SAISHO 0331, 1081
SAMPO 0361, 0941, 1021,
1111, 1151
SAMSUNG 0331, 0341, 0351,
0361, 0861, 0931,
0941, 0971, 1001,
1031, 1111, 1151
SAMSUX 0941
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page i Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
ii
SANYO 0171, 0231, 0271,
0661, 0801, 0911,
0981, 1231, 1251,
1261
SBR 1001
SCHEIDER 1001
SCIMITSU 1031
SCOTCH 0861
SCOTT 0831, 0861, 0941,
1031, 1051, 1091
SEARS 0101, 0161, 0171,
0351, 0481, 0521,
0621, 0761, 0801,
0861, 0971, 0981,
1091
SHANGHAI 1561, 1681
SHARP 0461, 0471, 0541,
0661, 0911, 0941,
1141
SHOGUN 1031
SIGNATURE 0991, 1771
SIMPSON 0581, 0961
SOLAVOX 1151
SONOKO 1001
SONTEC 1001
SONY 0371, 0451, 0661,
0841, 0951, 1281,
1441
SOUNDESIGN 0861, 0961, 1051,
1091
SOUNDWAVE 1001
SPECTRICON 1161
SQUAREVIEW 0481
SSS 1031, 1051
STAR-LITE 1051
SUPREM 0951
SUPRE-MACY 1131
SURPA 0351, 0971
SYLVANIA 0101, 0361, 0441,
0581, 0591, 0601,
0611, 0631, 0961,
1111
SYMPHONIC 0481
SYSLINE 1001
TANDY 0271, 0431, 1141
TATUNG 0271, 0881, 1001,
1041, 1161
TCL 1561, 1631, 1701
TECHNICS 0751
TECHWOOD 0351, 0751, 0971
TEKNIKA 0101, 0351, 0571,
0931, 0941, 0961,
0971, 0991, 1031,
1051, 1091, 1121,
1131, 1771
TELETECH 0331
TERA 0501
THAKRAL 1671
THORM 1001
TMK 0351, 0861, 0971,
1081
TOSHIBA 0381, 0521, 0621,
0661, 0931, 0981,
1301
TOSONIC 1011
TOTEVISION 0941
TRICAL 0911
UNIVERSAL 0781, 0791
UNIVERSUM 1001
VECTOR RESEARCH
0361, 1111
VESTEL 1001
VIDEO CONCEPT 1101
VIDIKRON 0101, 0211
VIDTECH 0861, 1031
VIKING 1131
WARDS 0101, 0361, 0451,
0541, 0581, 0591,
0601, 0611, 0771,
0781, 0791, 0861,
0971, 0991, 1031,
1091, 1111, 1771
WATSON 1001
XOGEGO 1611, 1621, 1661,
1741, 1761
YAMAHA 0361, 1031, 1111
YOKO 1001
ZENITH 0011, 0041, 0891,
0991, 1771
ZONDA 1161
CABLE TV
ABC 0256, 0376
ANTRONIX 0136
ARCHER 0136, 0286
BBT 0076
CABLETIME 0166
CABLEVISION 0196
COLOUR VOICE 0306, 0346
COMTRONICS 0216, 0276
EAGLE COMTRONICS
0276
EASTERN 0066
ELECTRICORD 0206
ELECTUS 0266
GE 0116, 0126
GEC CABLE SYSTEM
0196
HAMLIN H5 0676
HAMLIN H6 0666
HAMLIN H6S 0656
HAMLIN H8 0646
HAMLIN H9 0636
JERROLD 0256
JERROLD 400L 0626
JERROLD 450L 0616
JERROLD 550 0606
JERROLD OSD CATV
0596
JERROLD SPRUCER
0436
MAGNAVOX/PHILIPS
0416, 0426
MAMM 0296
MEMOREX 0386
MOVIE TIME 0146, 0206
NORTHCOAST 0016
NSC 0146
OAK 0106
OAK SIGMA 450 0546
OAK SIGMA 550 0536
PANASONIC TZ 120/130
0476
PANASONIC TZ 170/180
0446
PANASONIC TZ140 0466
PANASONIC TZ150/160
0456
PARAGON 0386
PHILIPS 0036, 0216, 0306,
0316, 0326, 0336,
0346
PIONEER 0006, 0086
PIONEER BR50 0846
PIONEER BR60/70/80/81/82
0696
PIONEER BR90 0556
PULSAR 0386
RCA DIGITAL SATELLITE
SYSTEM 0396, 0406
REALISTIC 0136
REGENCY/EASTERN0686
RUNCO 0386
SAMSUNG 0276
SCIENTIFIC ATLANTA 175/475
0576
SCIENTIFIC ATLANTA 75
0366, 0586
SCIENTIFIC ATLANTA 8650
0566
SIGNAL 0276
SL MARX 0276
SPECTAVISION 0236
STANDARD COMPONENTS
0186
STARCOM V 0256
STARGATE 0276
SYLVANIA/TEXSCAN
0376, 0496
TEKNIKA 0176
TELESERVICE 0056
TELEVIEW 0276
TEXSCAN 0186, 0376
TFC 0026
TOCOM 0226, 0356
TOCOM 5503A 0526
TOCOM 5503VIP/5507
0516
TOCOM TC56 0506
TOSHIBA 0386
TUDI 0046
UNIKA 0136
UNIVERSAL 0136, 0156, 0206,
0286
VIDEOWAY 0096
VIEWSTAR 0216
ZENITH 0246, 0386, 0486
SATELLITE TUNER
ALPHA STAR 0826
CHAPARRAL 0756
ECHOSTAR 0836
GENERAL INSTRUMENT
0776, 0876
HTS 0836
HUGHES NETWORK SYSTEMS
0816
JERROLD 0776, 0786
PANASONIC 0806
PRIMESTAR 0776, 0786
RCA 0766
SONY 0796
(DBS)
HITACHI 0856
MAGNAVOX 0886
MEMOREX 0886
PANASONIC 0896
PHILIPS 0886
SONY 0906
STAR CHOICE 0876
TOSHIBA 0866, 0916
UNIDEN 0886
VCR
A TANDY 0902
ADVENTURA 0992
AIKO 0982
AIWA 0992
AKAI 0262, 0942, 0952,
0962, 0972
AMERICAN HIGH 0932
AMSTRAD 0992
ASA 0002, 0912
ASHA 0922
AUDIO DYNAMICS 0202
AUDIOVOX 0912
BEAUMARK 0922
BELL & HOWELL 0902
BLAUPUNKT 0412
BROKSONIC 0872, 0882, 0892
BUSH 0852
CALIX 0912
CANON 0862, 0932
CCE 0852, 0982
CITIZEN 0912, 0982
COLT 0852
CRAIG 0832, 0842, 0852,
0912, 0922
CURTIS MATHES 0662, 0822,
0932
CYBERNEX 0922
DAEWOO 0802, 0812, 0982
DBX 0202
DYNATECH 0472, 0992
ELECTROHOME 0912
ELECTROPHONIC 0912
EMEREX 0792
EMERSON 0072, 0132, 0142,
0152, 0162, 0172,
0182, 0192, 0212,
0702, 0712, 0722,
0732, 0742, 0752,
0762, 0772, 0782,
0872, 0882, 0892,
0912, 0952, 0992,
1072
FINLUX 0002, 0992
FISHER 0682, 0692, 0842,
0902
FUJI 0672, 0932
FUNAI 0992
GARRARD 0992
GE 0662, 0822, 0932
GO VIDEO 0642, 0652
GOODMANS 0402
GRADIENTE 0992
GRANDA 0612, 0902
GRUNDIG 0002
HARLEY DAVIDSON
0992
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page ii Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
iii
HARMAN/KARDON
0632, 1082
HARWOOD 0752, 0852
HEADQUARTER 0612
HI-Q 0842
HINARI 0852
HITACHI 0102, 0562, 0572,
0582, 0592, 0602,
0992
ITT 0942
JVC (VICTOR) 0202, 0522, 0532,
0542, 0552
KENWOOD 0202, 0542, 0612,
0632, 0902
KLH 0852
KODAK 0912, 0932
LG (GOLDSTAR) 0082, 0632,
0912
LLOYD 0992
LOGIK 0852
LUXOR 0942
LXI 0022, 0912
MAGNAVOX 0002, 0482, 0492,
0502, 0512, 0932
MAGNIN 0922
MARANTZ 0002, 0202, 0402,
0632, 0932
MARTA 0912
MATSUSHITA 0932
MATSUI 0722
MEI 0222, 0932
MEMOREX 0232, 0242, 0472,
0512, 0612, 0842,
0902, 0912, 0922,
0932, 0992
MGA 0762, 0952
MGA TECHNOLOGY
0922
MINOLTA 0592, 0602
MITSUBISHI 0452, 0462, 0542,
0762, 0952, 1082
MOTOROLA 0472, 0932
MTC 0922, 0992
MULTITECH 0852, 0992
NAD 0442
NEC 0122, 0202, 0292,
0422, 0432, 0542,
0632
NIKKO 0912
NOBLEX 0922
OLYMPUS 0412, 0932
OPTIMUS 0442, 0472, 0912
OPTONICA 0402
ORION 0212, 0722, 0742,
0772
OSAKI 0912
PANASONIC 0012, 0052, 0092,
0222, 0372, 0382,
0392, 0412, 0932
PENNY 0202, 0432, 0602,
0632, 0692, 0912,
0922, 0932
PENTAX 0592, 0602
PERDIO 0992
PHILCO 0002, 0932
PHILIPS 0002, 0282, 0402,
0492, 0932
PILOT 0912
PIONEER 0442, 0542
PROSCAN 1002, 1012, 1022,
1032, 1042, 1052,
1062
PULSAR 0512
QUARTER 0612
QUARTZ 0272, 0612
QUASAR 0382, 0392, 0932
RADIO SHACK 0912, 0992
RADIX 0912
RANDEX 0912
RCA 0112, 0382, 0392,
0482, 0592, 0602,
0662, 0822, 0942
REALISTIC 0402, 0472, 0612,
0682, 0842, 0902,
0912, 0922, 0932,
0992
RICOH 0352, 0362
SAISHO 0212, 0582, 0722,
0732, 0742, 0772
SALORA 0612, 0762
SAMSUNG 0212, 0312, 0922,
0962
SANKY 0472, 0512
SANSUI 0292, 0542, 0832
SANYO 0242, 0612, 0842,
0902, 0922
SBR 0002, 0282
SCHEIDER 0852
SCOTT 0342, 0712, 0762,
0872, 0882, 0892
SEARS 0302, 0592, 0602,
0612, 0682, 0692,
0842, 0902, 0912,
0932
SHARP 0402, 0472
SHINTOM 0852
SHOGUN 0922
SINGER 0852
SONY 0032, 0332, 0352,
0362, 0672, 0792,
0932
STS 0602
SUNPAK 0352
SYLVANIA 0002, 0492, 0502,
0762, 0932, 0992
SYMPHONIC 0992
TANDY 0992
TASHIKO 0712, 0992
TEAC 0992
TECHNICS 0932
TEKNIKA 0322, 0912, 0932,
0992
TELEFUNKEN 0252
TMK 0212, 0732, 0772,
0922
TOSHIBA 0062, 0302, 0342,
0622, 0682, 0712,
0762
TOTEVISION 0912, 0922
UNITECH 0922
VECTOR RESEARCH
0202, 0432, 0632
VIDEO CONCEPTS
0202, 0432, 0632,
0952
WARDS 0322, 0402, 0472,
0482, 0602, 0712,
0842, 0852, 0922,
0932, 0992
YAMAHA 0202, 0632
ZENITH 0042, 0362, 0512,
0672
DVD PLAYER
AKAI 0058
AIWA 0218
DENON 0188
HITACHI 0198
JVC (VICTOR) 0088, 0178
KENWOOD 0148
LG (GOLDSTAR) 0228
MAGNAVOX 0128
MITSUBISHI 0138
ONKYO 0068, 0128
PANASONIC 0028
PHILIPS 0098, 0128
PIONEER 0108, 0118
PROSCAN 0158
RCA 0158
SAMSUNG 0078
SHARP 0038
SONY 0018
TECHNICS 0028
THOMSON 0168
TOSHIBA 0048, 0128
YAMAHA 0008, 0028, 0098
ZENITH 0128
DVD RECORDER
PANASONIC 0238, 0248, 0258
PHILIPS 0208
PIONEER 0278, 0288, 0298
TOSHIBA 0268
YAMAHA 0208
LD PLAYER
AIWA 0157
DENON 0147
DISCO VISION0017
FUNAI 0157
HITACHI (E) 0017
KENWOOD 0087, 0107
MAGNAVOX 0027
MARANTZ 0027
MITSUBISHI 0137
NAD 0137
PANASONIC 0077, 0177
PHILIPS 0027
PIONEER 0017, 0037, 0137
RCA 0167
REALISTIC 0157
SHARP 0127
SONY 0047, 0057, 0117
VICTOR 0097
YAMAHA 0007, 0067
CD PLAYER
ACOUSTIC RESEARCH
1295
ADC 0025, 0065
ADCOM 0205, 0255, 1015
ADS 0265
AIWA 0295, 0945, 1035,
1055
AKAI 0175, 0485, 0535
ALPINE 1215, 1305
AUDIO-TECHNICA 0545
BSR 0245, 0655, 0775
CALIFORNIA AUDIO LAB
0055
CAPETRONIC 1205
CARRERA 0245
CARVER 0285, 1135
CASIO 0345
CROWN 0185
CURTIS MATHES 0345
DENON 0275, 0875, 0885
DEUAL (E) 0505
DYNAMIC BASS (H)
0555
EMERSON 0205, 0325, 1105
EROICA 1275
FISHER 0095, 0555, 0925,
1005
GARRARD 0365
GENEXXA 0305, 0325, 1105
HARMAN/KARDON 0105, 0175,
0465, 0995
HITACHI 0195, 0205, 0505,
0815
INKEL 0115, 0395
JVC (VICTOR) 0315
KENWOOD 0045, 0095, 0405,
0585, 0725, 0735,
0745, 0755, 0895
KYOCERA 0025
LG (GOLDSTAR) 1135, 1225,
1265, 1335
LUXMAN 0075, 0425, 0675,
0705, 0715, 0985
MAGNAVOX 0165, 0215, 0645,
0955
MARANTZ 0215, 0235, 0375,
0785, 1345
MCINTOSH 0355, 1085
MCS 0905, 1315
MEMOREX 0205, 0225, 0235,
0305, 0325, 1105
MGA 0135
MISSION 0215
MITSUBISHI 0135, 0445
MTC 1255
NAD 0035, 0615, 0685,
0695
NAKAMICHI 0125, 0435, 0515
NEC 0255, 0905, 0965
NIKKO 0545, 1005
ONKYO 0155, 0455, 0495,
0805, 1155
OPTIMUS 0225, 0245, 0555,
0595, 0845, 0855,
0865, 0895, 0935
PANASONIC 0055, 0825, 1095,
1125
PENNY 0905
PHILIPS 0165, 0215
PIONEER 0305, 0935, 1045
PROTON 0215, 1185
QUASAR 0055
RCA 0205, 0915, 1115
REALISTIC 0205, 0225, 0235,
0325, 0555, 0845
REVOX 1175
ROTEL 0215
SABA TELECOMMANDER (E)
0505
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page iii Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
iv
SAE 0215
SAMSUNG 1285
SANSUI 0215, 0625, 0975,
1025, 1105
SANYO 0145, 0555, 0635,
0765
SCOTT 0325, 1105
SEARS 0345
SHARP 0235, 0665, 0895,
1065, 1075
SHERWOOD 0115, 0235, 0395,
0475
SIEMENTS GARRARD
1245
SIGNATURE 0175
SONTEC 1165
SONY 0065, 0565, 0865,
1145
STARON 1235
STS 0025
SYLVANIA 0215
SYMPHONIC 0335
TANDY 0305
TANGBERG 1195
TEAC 0235, 0335, 0385,
0525, 0795, 0835,
1355
TECHNICS 0055, 0605, 1095
TECHWOOD 1325
TELEFUNKEN (E) 0505
THOMSON (E) 0505
TOSHIBA 0035, 0685
VECTOR RESEARCH
0065, 1135
WARDS 0175
YAMAHA 0005, 0015, 0085,
0415, 0545, 0575,
1065
CD RECORDER
HITACHI 0474
JVC (VICTOR) 0504
MARANTZ 0484, 0494
PHILIPS 0444
PIONEER 0454
YAMAHA 0414
MD RECORDER
KENWOOD 0384
PIONEER 0424
SHARP 0434
SONY 0394
YAMAHA 0024, 0394, 0404,
0514
TAPE DECK
AIWA 0094, 0214, 0224
AKAI 0184
CARVER 0094
DENON 0304
FISHER 0144
GARRARD 0194, 0204
JVC (VICTOR) 0274, 0284, 0294
KENWOOD 0124, 0134, 0154,
0234, 0244, 0264
MAGNAVOX 0094
MARANTZ 0094, 0344
MITSUBISHI 0184
OPTIMUS 0034, 0064, 0204,
0334
ONKYO 0364, 0374
PHILIPS 0094
PIONEER 0034, 0044, 0064
REVOX 0354
SANSUI 0094, 0344
SHARP 0264
SHERWOOD 0334
SONY 0054, 0084, 0324
TEAC 0194, 0254
TECHNICS 0074, 0314
WARDS 0034
YAMAHA 0004, 0014, 0104,
0114, 0164, 0174,
0264
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page iv Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM
YAMAHA ELECTRONICS CORPORATION, USA
6660 ORANGETHORPE AVE., BUENA PARK, CALIF. 90620, U.S.A.
YAMAHA CANADA MUSIC LTD.
135 MILNER AVE., SCARBOROUGH, ONTARIO M1S 3R1, CANADA
YAMAHA ELECTRONIK EUROPA G.m.b.H.
SIEMENSSTR. 22-34, 25462 RELLINGEN BEI HAMBURG, F.R. OF GERMANY
YAMAHA ELECTRONIQUE FRANCE S.A.
RUE AMBROISE CROIZAT BP70 CROISSY-BEAUBOURG 77312 MARNE-LA-VALLEE CEDEX02, FRANCE
YAMAHA ELECTRONICS (UK) LTD.
YAMAHA HOUSE, 200 RICKMANSWORTH ROAD WATFORD, HERTS WD18 7GQ, ENGLAND
YAMAHA SCANDINAVIA A.B.
J A WETTERGRENS GATA 1, BOX 30053, 400 43 VÄSTRA FRÖLUNDA, SWEDEN
YAMAHA MUSIC AUSTRALIA PTY, LTD.
17-33 MARKET ST., SOUTH MELBOURNE, 3205 VIC., AUSTRALIA
©
2004 All rights reserved.
Printed in Malaysia WC85400
00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 1 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM

Transcripción de documentos

00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 1 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM U RX-V550 AV Receiver OWNER'S MANUAL 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page i Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS 10 CAUTION RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK DO NOT OPEN CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL. • Explanation of Graphical Symbols The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an equilateral triangle, is intended to alert you to the presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within the product’s enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to persons. The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert you to the presence of important operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in the literature accompanying the appliance. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 i 11 Read Instructions – All the safety and operating instructions should be read before the product is operated. Retain Instructions – The safety and operating instructions should be retained for future reference. Heed Warnings – All warnings on the product and in the operating instructions should be adhered to. Follow Instructions – All operating and use instructions should be followed. Cleaning – Unplug this product from the wall outlet before cleaning. Do not use liquid cleaners or aerosol cleaners. Use a damp cloth for cleaning. Attachments – Do not use attachments not recommended by the product manufacturer as they may cause hazards. Water and Moisture – Do not use this product near water – for example, near a bath tub, wash bowl, kitchen sink, or laundry tub; in a wet basement; or near a swimming pool; and the like. Accessories – Do not place this product on an unstable cart, stand, tripod, bracket, or table. The product may fall, causing serious injury to a child or adult, and serious damage to the product. Use only with a cart, stand, tripod, bracket, or table recommended by the manufacturer, or sold with the product. Any mounting of the product should follow the manufacturer’s instructions, and should use a mounting accessory recommended by the manufacturer. A product and cart combination should be moved with care. Quick stops, excessive force, and uneven surfaces may cause the product and cart combination to overturn. 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 Ventilation – Slots and openings in the cabinet are provided for ventilation and to ensure reliable operation of the product and to protect it from overheating, and these openings must not be blocked or covered. The openings should never be blocked by placing the product on a bed, sofa, rug, or other similar surface. This product should not be placed in a built-in installation such as a bookcase or rack unless proper ventilation is provided or the manufacturer’s instructions have been adhered to. Power Sources – This product should be operated only from the type of power source indicated on the marking label. If you are not sure of the type of power supply to your home, consult your product dealer or local power company. For products intended to operate from battery power, or other sources, refer to the operating instructions. Grounding or Polarization – This product may be equipped with a polarized alternating current line plug (a plug having one blade wider than the other). This plug will fit into the power outlet only one way. This is a safety feature. If you are unable to insert the plug fully into the outlet, try reversing the plug. If the plug should still fail to fit, contact your electrician to replace your obsolete outlet. Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized plug. Power-Cord Protection – Power-supply cords should be routed so that they are not likely to be walked on or pinched by items placed upon or against them, paying particular attention to cords at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the point where they exit from the product. Lightning – For added protection for this product during a lightning storm, or when it is left unattended and unused for long periods of time, unplug it from the wall outlet and disconnect the antenna or cable system. This will prevent damage to the product due to lightning and power-line surges. Power Lines – An outside antenna system should not be located in the vicinity of overhead power lines or other electric light or power circuits, or where it can fall into such power lines or circuits. When installing an outside antenna system, extreme care should be taken to keep from touching such power lines or circuits as contact with them might be fatal. Overloading – Do not overload wall outlets, extension cords, or integral convenience receptacles as this can result in a risk of fire or electric shock. Object and Liquid Entry – Never push objects of any kind into this product through openings as they may touch dangerous voltage points or short-out parts that could result in a fire or electric shock. Never spill liquid of any kind on the product. Servicing – Do not attempt to service this product yourself as opening or removing covers may expose you to dangerous voltage or other hazards. Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel. Damage Requiring Service – Unplug this product from the wall outlet and refer servicing to qualified service personnel under the following conditions: a) When the power-supply cord or plug is damaged, b) If liquid has been spilled, or objects have fallen into the product, c) If the product has been exposed to rain or water, 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page ii Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS d) 20 21 22 23 If the product does not operate normally by following the operating instructions. Adjust only those controls that are covered by the operating instructions as an improper adjustment of other controls may result in damage and will often require extensive work by a qualified technician to restore the product to its normal operation, e) If the product has been dropped or damaged in any way, and f) When the product exhibits a distinct change in performance - this indicates a need for service. Replacement Parts – When replacement parts are required, be sure the service technician has used replacement parts specified by the manufacturer or have the same characteristics as the original part. Unauthorized substitutions may result in fire, electric shock, or other hazards. Safety Check – Upon completion of any service or repairs to this product, ask the service technician to perform safety checks to determine that the product is in proper operating condition. Wall or Ceiling Mounting – The unit should be mounted to a wall or ceiling only as recommended by the manufacturer. Heat – The product should be situated away from heat sources such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other products (including amplifiers) that produce heat. 24 Outdoor Antenna Grounding – If an outside antenna or cable system is connected to the product, be sure the antenna or cable system is grounded so as to provide some protection against voltage surges and built-up static charges. Article 810 of the National Electrical Code, ANSI/NFPA 70, provides information with regard to proper grounding of the mast and supporting structure, grounding of the lead-in wire to an antenna discharge unit, size of grounding conductors, location of antenna discharge unit, connection to grounding electrodes, and requirements for the grounding electrode. EXAMPLE OF ANTENNA GROUNDING MAST ANTENNA LEAD IN WIRE GROUND CLAMP ANTENNA DISCHARGE UNIT (NEC SECTION 810–20) ELECTRIC SERVICE EQUIPMENT GROUNDING CONDUCTORS (NEC SECTION 810–21) GROUND CLAMPS Note to CATV system installer: This reminder is provided to call the CATV system installer’s attention to Article 820-40 of the NEC that provides guidelines for proper grounding and, in particular, specifies that the cable ground shall be connected to the grounding system of the building, as close to the point of cable entry as practical. POWER SERVICE GROUNDING ELECTRODE SYSTEM (NEC ART 250. PART H) NEC – NATIONAL ELECTRICAL CODE FCC INFORMATION (for US customers) 1 IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS UNIT! This product, when installed as indicated in the instructions contained in this manual, meets FCC requirements. Modifications not expressly approved by Yamaha may void your authority, granted by the FCC, to use the product. 2 IMPORTANT: When connecting this product to accessories and/or another product use only high quality shielded cables. Cable/s supplied with this product MUST be used. Follow all installation instructions. Failure to follow instructions could void your FCC authorization to use this product in the USA. 3 NOTE: This product has been tested and found to comply with the requirements listed in FCC Regulations, Part 15 for Class “B” digital devices. Compliance with these requirements provides a reasonable level of assurance that your use of this product in a residential environment will not result in harmful interference with other electronic devices. This equipment generates/uses radio frequencies and, if not installed and used according to the instructions found in the users manual, may cause interference harmful to the operation of other electronic devices. Compliance with FCC regulations does not guarantee that interference will not occur in all installations. If this product is found to be the source of interference, which can be determined by turning the unit “OFF” and “ON”, please try to eliminate the problem by using one of the following measures: Relocate either this product or the device that is being affected by the interference. Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit breaker or fuse) circuits or install AC line filter/s. In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient the antenna. If the antenna lead-in is 300 ohm ribbon lead, change the lead-in to coaxial type cable. If these corrective measures do not produce satisfactory results, please contact the local retailer authorized to distribute this type of product. If you can not locate the appropriate retailer, please contact Yamaha Electronics Corp., U.S.A. 6660 Orangethorpe Ave, Buena Park, CA 90620. The above statements apply ONLY to those products distributed by Yamaha Corporation of America or its subsidiaries. ii 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page iii Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CAUTION: READ THIS BEFORE OPERATING YOUR UNIT. CAUTION: READ THIS BEFORE OPERATING YOUR UNIT. 1 To assure the finest performance, please read this manual carefully. Keep it in a safe place for future reference. 2 Install this sound system in a well ventilated, cool, dry, clean place — away from direct sunlight, heat sources, vibration, dust, moisture, and/or cold. Allow ventilation space of at least 30 cm on the top, 20 cm on the left and right, and 20 cm on the back of this unit. 3 Locate this unit away from other electrical appliances, motors, or transformers to avoid humming sounds. 4 Do not expose this unit to sudden temperature changes from cold to hot, and do not locate this unit in a environment with high humidity (i.e. a room with a humidifier) to prevent condensation inside this unit, which may cause an electrical shock, fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury. 5 Avoid installing this unit where foreign object may fall onto this unit and/or this unit may be exposed to liquid dripping or splashing. On the top of this unit, do not place: – Other components, as they may cause damage and/or discoloration on the surface of this unit. – Burning objects (i.e. candles), as they may cause fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury. – Containers with liquid in them, as they may fall and liquid may cause electrical shock to the user and/or damage to this unit. 6 Do not cover this unit with a newspaper, tablecloth, curtain, etc. in order not to obstruct heat radiation. If the temperature inside this unit rises, it may cause fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury. 7 Do not plug in this unit to a wall outlet until all connections are complete. 8 Do not operate this unit upside-down. It may overheat, possibly causing damage. 9 Do not use force on switches, knobs and/or cords. 10 When disconnecting the power cord from the wall outlet, grasp the plug; do not pull the cord. 11 Do not clean this unit with chemical solvents; this might damage the finish. Use a clean, dry cloth. 12 Only voltage specified on this unit must be used. Using this unit with a higher voltage than specified is dangerous and may cause fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury. YAMAHA will not be held responsible for any damage resulting from use of this unit with a voltage other than specified. 13 To prevent damage by lightning, disconnect the power cord from the wall outlet during an electrical storm. 14 Do not attempt to modify or fix this unit. Contact qualified YAMAHA service personnel when any service is needed. The cabinet should never be opened for any reasons. 15 When not planning to use this unit for long periods of time (i.e. vacation), disconnect the AC power plug from the wall outlet. 16 Be sure to read the “TROUBLESHOOTING” section on common operating errors before concluding that this unit is faulty. 17 Before moving this unit, press STANDBY/ON to set this unit in the standby mode, and disconnect the AC power plug from the wall outlet. 18 VOLTAGE SELECTOR (Asia and General models only) The VOLTAGE SELECTOR on the rear panel of this unit must be set for your local main voltage BEFORE plugging into the AC main supply. Voltages are: Asia model ...................... 220/230-240 V AC, 50/60 Hz General model .. 110/120/220/230-240 V AC, 50/60 Hz WARNING TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS UNIT TO RAIN OR MOISTURE. This unit is not disconnected from the AC power source as long as it is connected to the wall outlet, even if this unit itself is turned off. This state is called the standby mode. In this state, this unit is designed to consume a very small quantity of power. FOR CANADIAN CUSTOMERS To prevent electric shock, match wide blade of plug to wide slot and fully insert. This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003. IMPORTANT Please record the serial number of this unit in the space below. MODEL: Serial No.: The serial number is located on the rear of the unit. Retain this Owner’s Manual in a safe place for future reference. We Want You Listening For A Lifetime YAMAHA and the Electronic Industries Association's Consumer Electronics Group want you to get the most out of your equipment by playing it at a safe level. One that lets the sound come through loud and clear without annoying blaring or distortion - and, most importantly, without affecting your sensitive hearing. iii Since hearing damage from loud sounds is often undetectable until it is too late, YAMAHA and the Electronic Industries Association’s Consumer Electronics Group recommend you to avoid prolonged exposure from excessive volume levels. 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 1 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CONTENTS INTRODUCTION INTRODUCTION SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS FEATURES............................................................. 2 GETTING STARTED............................................ 3 SOUND FIELD PROGRAM DESCRIPTIONS...............................................40 Supplied accessories .................................................. 3 Installing batteries in the remote control ................... 3 For movie/video sources.......................................... 40 For music sources .................................................... 42 CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS ......................... 4 PREPARATION ADVANCED OPERATION ADVANCED OPERATIONS ..............................43 Using the sleep timer ............................................... 43 Manually adjusting speaker levels........................... 44 Using the test tone ................................................... 44 SET MENU ............................................................45 CONNECTIONS .................................................. 14 REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES ...................51 Before connecting components................................ 14 Connecting video components................................. 15 Connecting audio components................................. 18 Connecting the antennas .......................................... 19 Connecting the power supply cord .......................... 20 Turning on the power............................................... 22 Control area ............................................................. 51 Setting manufacturer codes...................................... 52 Controlling other components ................................. 53 Clearing setup manufacturer codes.......................... 54 BASIC SETUP ...................................................... 23 Using the BASIC SETUP menu .............................. 23 PLAYBACK.......................................................... 26 Basic operations....................................................... 26 Selecting sound field programs ............................... 28 Selecting input modes.............................................. 32 TUNING ................................................................ 34 RECORDING ....................................................... 39 Zone 2 connections .................................................. 55 Remote controlling Zone 2 ...................................... 56 ADDITIONAL INFORMATION EDITING SOUND FIELD PARAMETERS ......58 What is a sound field ............................................... 58 Changing parameter settings ................................... 58 SOUND FIELD PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS...............................................60 TROUBLESHOOTING .......................................62 RESETTING THE FACTORY PRESETS ........66 GLOSSARY...........................................................67 ADVANCED OPERATION Automatic and manual tuning.................................. 34 Presetting stations .................................................... 35 Selecting preset stations........................................... 37 Exchanging preset stations ...................................... 38 ZONE 2 (U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only) ....................................................................55 SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS BASIC OPERATION BASIC OPERATION Speaker placement ................................................... 11 Speaker connections ................................................ 12 Using SET MENU................................................... 46 1 SOUND MENU.................................................... 47 2 INPUT MENU...................................................... 49 3 OPTION MENU................................................... 50 SPEAKER SETUP ............................................... 11 PREPARATION Front panel ................................................................. 4 Remote control........................................................... 6 Using the remote control ........................................... 7 Front panel display .................................................... 8 Rear panel ................................................................ 10 Audio formats .......................................................... 67 Sound field programs............................................... 68 Audio information ................................................... 68 Video signal information ......................................... 69 SPECIFICATIONS...............................................70 ADDITIONAL INFORMATION English 1 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 2 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM FEATURES FEATURES Built-in 6-channel power amplifier Other features ◆ Minimum RMS output power (0.06% THD, 20 Hz – 20 kHz, 8Ω) Front: 90 W + 90 W Center: 90 W Surround: 90 W + 90 W Surround back: 90 W ◆ 192-kHz/24-bit D/A converter ◆ A SET MENU which provides you with items for optimizing this unit for your audio/video system ◆ 6 additional input jacks for discrete multi-channel input ◆ S-Video signal input/output capability ◆ Component video input/output capability ◆ Video signal conversion (Composite video ↔ S-Video) capability for monitor out ◆ Optical and coaxial digital audio signal jacks ◆ Sleep timer ◆ Cinema and music night listening modes ◆ Remote control with preset manufacturer codes ◆ Zone 2 custom installation facility (U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only) Sound field features ◆ Proprietary YAMAHA technology for the creation of sound fields ◆ Dolby Digital/Dolby Digital EX decoder ◆ DTS/DTS ES Matrix 6.1, Discrete 6.1, DTS Neo:6, DTS 96/24 decoder ◆ Dolby Pro Logic/Dolby Pro Logic II/Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder ◆ Virtual CINEMA DSP ◆ SILENT CINEMA™ Sophisticated AM/FM tuner ◆ 40-station random access preset tuning ◆ Automatic preset tuning ◆ Preset station shifting capability (preset editing) • y indicates a tip for your operation. • Some operations can be performed by using either the buttons on the main unit or on the remote control. In cases when the button names differ between the main unit and the remote control, the button name on the remote control is given in parentheses. • This manual is printed prior to production. Design and specifications are subject to change in part as a result of improvements, etc. In case of differences between the manual and product, the product has priority. Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. “Dolby”, “Pro Logic”, “Surround EX”, and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories. “SILENT CINEMA” is a trademark of YAMAHA CORPORATION. 2 “DTS”, “DTS-ES”, “Neo:6” and “DTS 96/24” are trademarks of Digital Theater Systems, Inc. 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 3 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM GETTING STARTED GETTING STARTED INTRODUCTION Supplied accessories Please check that you received all of the following parts. Remote control CODE SET TRANSMIT Batteries (4) (AAA, R03, UM-4) SYSTEM POWER POWER STANDBY POWER TV AV CD MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DVD DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN AM loop antenna 75-ohm/300-ohm antenna adapter (U.K. model only) AMP VCR TV VOL TV CH TV MUTE TV INPUT STEREO HALL JAZZ 1 2 3 4 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 9 0 VOLUME MUTE 10 ROCK ENTER Indoor FM antenna (U.S.A., Canada, China, Asia and General models) EFFECT PRESET/CH LEVEL TITLE SET MENU MENU A/B/C/D/E SELECT TEST RETURN Indoor FM antenna (U.K., Europe, Australia and Korea models) DISPLAY REC AUDIO DISC SKIP FREQ/RDS MODE PTY SEEK START EON RAV251 WC55290 EU Installing batteries in the remote control 2 1 3 Notes on batteries • Change all of the batteries if you notice the condition like; the operation range of the remote control decreases, the indicator does not flash or its light becomes dim. • Do not use old batteries together with new ones. • Do not use different types of batteries (such as alkaline and manganese batteries) together. Read the packaging carefully as these different types of batteries may have the same shape and color. • If the batteries have leaked, dispose of them immediately. Avoid touching the leaked material or letting it come into contact with clothing, etc. Clean the battery compartment thoroughly before installing new batteries. If the remote control is without batteries for more than 2 minutes, or if exhausted batteries remain in the remote control, the contents of the memory may be cleared. When the memory is cleared, insert new batteries, set up the manufacturer code and program any acquired functions that may have been cleared. Press the part and slide the battery compartment cover off. 2 Insert four supplied batteries (AAA, R03, UM-4) according to the polarity markings (+ and –) on the inside of the battery compartment. 3 Slide the cover back until it snaps into place. English 1 3 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 4 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS Front panel 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 9 8 (U.S.A. model) VOLUME PRESET/TUNING FM/AM EDIT A/B/C/D/E l PRESET/TUNING h MEMORY TUNING MODE NEXT LEVEL MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO PROGRAM INPUT PHONES SPEAKERS A B STRAIGHT TONE CONTROL MULTI CH INPUT INPUT MODE STANDBY /ON VIDEO AUX EFFECT SILENT CINEMA VIDEO RDS MODE/FREQ L AUDIO R EON PTY SEEK MODE START 0 A BC D E F G H I JK LM (U.K. and Europe models only) 1 STANDBY/ON Turns on this unit or sets it to the standby mode. When you turn on this unit, you will hear a click and there will be a 4 to 5-second delay before this unit can reproduce sound. Note In standby mode, this unit consumes a small amount of power in order to receive infrared-signals from the remote control. 5 PRESET/TUNING l / h (LEVEL –/+) Selects preset station number 1 to 8 when the colon (:) is displayed next to the band indication in the front panel display when the unit is in tuner mode. Selects the tuning frequency when the colon (:) is not displayed. Adjusts the level of the speaker channel selected using A/B/C/D/E (NEXT) when the unit is not in tuner mode. 2 Remote control sensor Receives signals from the remote control. 6 MEMORY (MAN’L/AUTO FM) Stores a station in the memory. Hold down this button for more than 3 seconds to start automatic preset tuning. 3 Front panel display Shows information about the operational status of this unit. 7 TUNING MODE (AUTO/MAN’L MONO) Switches between automatic tuning (AUTO indicator on) and manual tuning (AUTO indicator off). 4 A/B/C/D/E (NEXT) Selects one of the 5 preset station groups (A to E) when the unit is in tuner mode. Selects the speaker channel to be adjusted when the unit is not in tuner mode. 8 VIDEO AUX jacks Input audio and video signals from a portable external source such as a game console. To reproduce source signals from these jacks, select V-AUX as the input source. 4 9 VOLUME Controls the output level of all audio channels. This does not affect the REC OUT level. 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 5 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS A SPEAKERS A/B Turns on or off the set of front speakers connected to the A and/or B terminals on the rear panel each time the corresponding button is pressed. B PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) Switches the function of PRESET/TUNING l / h (LEVEL –/+) between selecting preset station numbers and tuning. C STRAIGHT (EFFECT) Switches the sound fields off or on. When STRAIGHT is selected, input signals (2-channel or multi-channel) are output directly from their respective speakers without effect processing. ■ U.K. and Europe models only J RDS MODE/FREQ Press this button when the unit is receiving an RDS station to cycle the display between the PS mode, PTY mode, RT mode, CT mode (if the station offers those RDS data services) and/or the frequency display. K PTY SEEK MODE Press this button to set the unit to the PTY SEEK mode. INTRODUCTION 0 PHONES (SILENT CINEMA) jack Outputs audio signals for private listening with headphones. When you connect headphones, no signals are output to the OUTPUT jacks or to the speakers. All Dolby Digital and DTS audio signals are mixed down to the left and right headphone channels. L PTY SEEK START Press this button to begin searching for a station after the desired program type has been selected in the PTY SEEK mode. M EON Press this button to select a radio program type (NEWS, INFO, AFFAIRS, SPORT) to tune in automatically. D FM/AM Switches the reception band between FM and AM. E PROGRAM Use to select sound field programs or adjust the bass/treble balance (in conjunction with TONE CONTROL). F TONE CONTROL Use to adjust the bass/treble balance for the front left and right speakers (see page 27). G INPUT MODE Sets the priority (AUTO, DTS, ANALOG) for the type of signals received when one component is connected to two or more of this unit’s input jacks (see page 32). H INPUT selector Selects the input source you want to listen to or watch. I MULTI CH INPUT Selects the source connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks. When selected, the MULTI CH INPUT source takes priority over the source selected with INPUT (or the input selector buttons on the remote control). English 5 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 6 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS Remote control This section describes the function of each control on the remote control used to control this unit. To operate other components, see “REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES” on page 51. 1 2 9 CODE SET TRANSMIT SYSTEM 3 STANDBY 0 POWER POWER POWER TV AV CD MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DVD DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN A AMP VCR B C D E TV VOL TV CH TV MUTE TV INPUT VOLUME F MUTE 4 STEREO HALL JAZZ 1 2 3 4 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 9 0 5 6 10 ENTER G H EFFECT PRESET/CH LEVEL TITLE SET MENU MENU A/B/C/D/E 7 8 ROCK I TEST DISPLAY AUDIO DISC SKIP MODE PTY SEEK START EON 5 NIGHT Turns on or off the night listening modes (page 31). 6 LEVEL Selects the speaker channel to be adjusted and sets the level. 7 Cursor buttons u / d / j / i / SELECT Use to select and adjust sound field program parameters or SET MENU items. Press u / d to select preset station numbers when the unit is in tuner mode. 8 TEST (RETURN) Outputs the test tone to adjust the speaker levels. Returns to the previous menu level when adjusting the SET MENU parameters. 9 TRANSMIT indicator Flashes while the remote control is sending signals. 0 STANDBY Sets this unit in the standby mode. B SLEEP Sets the sleep timer. REC FREQ/RDS 4 Sound field program / numeric buttons (1 - 8) Use to select sound field programs. Use numbers 1 through 8 to select preset stations when the unit is in tuner mode. A SYSTEM POWER Turns on the power of this unit. SELECT RETURN 3 Input selector buttons Select the input source and change the control area. J C MULTI CH IN Selects MULTI CH INPUT when using an external decoder (etc.). D AMP Selects the AMP mode. You must select the AMP mode to control the main unit. E VOLUME –/+ Increases or decreases the volume level. 1 Infrared window Outputs infrared control signals. Aim this window at the component you want to operate. 2 CODE SET Use to set up manufacturer codes (see page 52). 6 F MUTE Mutes the sound. Press again to restore the audio output to the previous volume level. G EX/ES Switches between 5.1 or 6.1-channel playback of multichannel software. 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 7 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS Using the remote control The remote control transmits a directional infrared beam. Be sure to aim the remote control directly at the remote control sensor on the main unit during operation. I SET MENU (A/B/C/D/E) Activates the SET MENU function. Selects preset station groups when the unit is in tuner mode. RDS MODE/FREQ VOLUME FM/AM A/B/C/D/E l PRESET/TUNING h NEXT EDIT ■ U.K. and Europe models only EON PTY SEEK MODE START PRESET/TUNING LEVEL PROGRAM MEMORY TUNING MODE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO INPUT PHONES STRAIGHT SPEAKERS A B TONE CONTROL INPUT MODE MULTI CH INPUT STANDBY /ON VIDEO AUX EFFECT SILENT CINEMA VIDEO J RDS tuning buttons FREQ/RDS Press this button when the unit is receiving an RDS station to cycle the display between the PS mode, PTY mode, RT mode, CT mode (if the station offers those RDS data service) and/or the frequency display. INTRODUCTION H STRAIGHT (EFFECT) Switches the sound fields off or on. When STRAIGHT is selected, input signals (2-channel or multi-channel) are output directly from their respective speakers without effect processing. 30 30 CODE SET L AUDIO R Approximately 6 m (20 ft) TRANSMIT SYSTEM POWER POWER STANDBY POWER TV CD DVD AV MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN VCR AMP TV VOL TV CH VOLUME TV MUTE TV INPUT STEREO HALL JAZZ 1 2 3 MUTE MUSIC ENTERTAINTV THTR 5 6 7 q/DTS NIGHT 9 0 ROCK 4 MOVIE 8 EX/ES STRAIGHT 10 ENTER EFFECT LEVEL PRESET/CH TITLE SET MENU MENU A/B/C/D/E SELECT TEST RETURN DISPLAY REC AUDIO DISC SKIP PTY SEEK MODE Press this button to set the unit to the PTY SEEK mode. PTY SEEK START Press this button to begin searching for a station after the desired program type has been selected in the PTY SEEK mode. EON Press this button to select a radio program type (NEWS, INFO, AFFAIRS, SPORT) to tune in automatically. ■ Handling the remote control • Do not spill water or other liquids on the remote control. • Do not drop the remote control. • Do not leave or store the remote control in the following types of conditions: – high humidity such as near a bath – high temperature such as near a heater or stove – extremely low temperatures – dusty places English 7 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 8 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS Front panel display 1 2 t 96 24 q EX q PL 3 VCR SILENT CINEMA MATRIX DISCRETE VIRTUAL SP AB q DIGITAL 4 5 V-AUX 6 DTV/CBL 78 MD/CD-R DVD NIGHT ZONE2 PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP SLEEP PS 90 TUNER CD PTY RT CT EON dB ft mS dB D E H F G M (U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only) 1 Decoder indicators When any of this unit’s decoders function, the respective indicator lights up. 2 SILENT CINEMA indicator Lights up when headphones are connected and a sound field program is selected (see page 27). 3 NIGHT indicator Lights up when you select night listening mode. 4 Input source indicators A cursor lights to show the current input source. 5 Sound field indicators Light to indicate the active DSP sound fields. Presence DSP sound field Listening position Left surround DSP sound field Right surround DSP sound field Surround back DSP sound field 6 CINEMA DSP indicator Lights up when you select a CINEMA DSP sound field program. I 96/24 L C R LFE SL SB SR JK N B TUNED STEREO MEMORY MUTE VOLUME q PL q PL x PCM C A L (U.K. and Europe models only) 0 MEMORY indicator Blinks to show that a station can be stored. A MUTE indicator Blinks while the MUTE function is on. B VOLUME level indication Indicates the volume level. C PCM indicator Lights up when this unit is reproducing PCM (pulse code modulation) digital audio signals. D VIRTUAL indicator Lights up when Virtual CINEMA DSP is active (see page 32). E Headphones indicator Lights up when headphones are connected. F SP A B indicators Light up according to the set of front speakers selected. Both indicators light up when both sets of speakers are selected. G SLEEP indicator Lights up while the sleep timer is on. 7 AUTO indicator Lights up to indicate that automatic tuning is possible. H HiFi DSP Lights when you select a HiFi DSP sound field program. 8 TUNED indicator Lights up when this unit is tuned into a station. I Multi-information display Shows the current sound field program name and other information when adjusting or changing settings. 9 STEREO indicator Lights up when this unit is receiving a strong signal for an FM stereo broadcast while the AUTO indicator is lit. 8 J 96/24 indicator Lights up when a DTS 96/24 signal is input to this unit. 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 9 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS K LFE indicator Lights up when the input signal contains the LFE signal. INTRODUCTION L Input channel indicators/speaker indicators Indicate the channel components of the current digital input signal. Indicate the number of speakers connected in SPEAKERS (page 24), or indicate the channel being adjusted in SP LEVEL (page 48). M ZONE 2 indicator (U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only) Lights up when Zone 2 power is on. N RDS indicators (U.K. and Europe models only) The name(s) of the RDS data offered by the currently received RDS station light(s) up. EON lights up when an RDS station that offers the EON data service is being received. PTY HOLD lights up while searching for stations in the PTY SEEK mode. English 9 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 10 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS Rear panel 1 2 3 4 5 6 COMPONENT VIDEO Y PB PR DVD MULTI CH INPUT R L AUDIO R VIDEO L FRONT VIDEO S VIDEO COAXIAL ZONE 2 MONITOR OUT DTV /CBL CD SURROUND OPTICAL REMOTE DTV /CBL DVD DIGITAL INPUT TUNER OUT IN +12V 15mA MAX. VCR DVD MD/CD-R AM ANT OUT CD + SPEAKERS + + – – + – – GND IN (PLAY) IMPEDANCE SELECTOR A MD /CD-R ZONE 2 OUT (REC) SUB WOOFER VIDEO AUDIO R L SURROUND S VIDEO B 75Ω UNBAL. MONITOR OUT FM ANT L R MD/CD-R SWITCHED CONTROL OUT CENTER SUB WOOFER DTV/CBL AC OUTLETS IN OUTPUT + OPTICAL + + – – R FRONT L + – – CENTER SURROUND BACK DIGITAL OUTPUT (U.S.A. model) 7 8 9 0 A 1 DIGITAL INPUT jacks See pages 15, 17 and 18 for details. 2 MULTI CH INPUT jacks See page 16 for connection information. 3 Video component jacks See pages 15 and 17 for connection information. 4 REMOTE IN/OUT jacks (U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only) See page 55 for details. 5 CONTROL OUT jack (U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only) This is a control expansion terminal for commercial use. 6 AC OUTLET(S) Use to supply power to your other A/V components (see page 20). 7 DIGITAL OUTPUT jack See page 18 for details. 8 Audio component jacks See page 18 for connection information. 10 B C 9 ZONE 2 OUTPUT jacks (U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only) See page 55 for details. 0 SUB WOOFER OUTPUT jack See page 13 for connection information. A Antenna terminals See page 19 for connection information. B Speaker terminals See page 13 for connection information. C IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch See page 21. < Asia and General models only > FREQUENCY STEP switch See page 19. VOLTAGE SELECTOR See page 20. 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 11 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM SPEAKER SETUP SPEAKER SETUP Surround speakers (SR and SL) Speaker placement The speaker layout below shows the standard ITU-R speaker setting. You can use it to enjoy CINEMA DSP and multi-channel audio sources. The surround speakers are used for effect and surround sounds. Place these speakers behind your listening position, facing slightly inwards, about 1.8 m (6 ft) above the floor. Surround back speaker (SB) FL C FR 30˚ Subwoofer SL SR 60˚ SL 80˚ SR SB The use of a subwoofer, such as the YAMAHA Active Servo Processing Subwoofer System, is effective not only for reinforcing bass frequencies from any or all channels, but also for high fidelity reproduction of the LFE (lowfrequency effect) channel included in Dolby Digital and DTS software. The position of the subwoofer is not so critical, because low bass sounds are not highly directional. But it is better to place the subwoofer near the front speakers. Turn it slightly toward the center of the room to reduce wall reflections. PREPARATION The surround back speaker supplements the surround speakers and provides for more realistic front-to-back transitions. Place this speaker directly behind the listening position and at the same height as the surround speakers. 1.8 m (6 ft) Front speakers (FR and FL) The front speakers are used for the main source sound plus effect sounds. Place these speakers an equal distance from the ideal listening position. The distance of each speaker from each side of the video monitor should be the same. Center speaker (C) The center speaker is for the center channel sounds (dialog, vocals, etc.). If for some reason it is not practical to use a center speaker, you can do without it. Best results, however, are obtained with the full system. Align the front face of the center speaker with the front face of your video monitor. Place the speaker centrally between the front speakers and as close to the monitor as possible, such as directly over or under it. English 11 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 12 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM SPEAKER SETUP Speaker connections 5 Tighten the knob to secure the wire. Be sure to connect the left channel (L), right channel (R), “+” (red) and “–” (black) properly. If the connections are faulty, no sound will be heard from the speakers, and if the polarity of the speaker connections is incorrect, the sound will be unnatural and lack bass. • • • • CAUTION If you will use 6 ohm speakers, be sure to set this unit’s speaker impedance setting to 6 ohms before using (see page 21). Before connecting the speakers, make sure that the power of this unit is off. Do not let the bare speaker wires touch each other or do not let them touch any metal part of this unit. This could damage this unit and/or speakers. Use magnetically shielded speakers. If this type of speakers still creates the interference with the monitor, place the speakers away from the monitor. A speaker cord is actually a pair of insulated cables running side by side. One cable is colored or shaped differently, perhaps with a stripe, groove or ridges. Connect the striped (grooved, etc.) cable to the “+” (red) terminals on this unit and your speaker. Connect the plain cable to the “–” (black) terminals. 2 1 Remove approximately 10 mm (3/8") of insulation from the end of each speaker cable. 2 Twist the exposed wires of the cable together to prevent short circuits. 3 Unscrew the knob. 4 Insert one bare wire into the hole in the side of each terminal. 12 4 5 Red: positive (+) Black: negative (–) ■ Banana plug connections (With the exception of U.K., Europe and Asia models) First, tighten the knob and then insert the banana plug connector into the end of the corresponding terminal. Banana plug (With the exception of U.K., Europe and Asia models) 10 mm (3/8") 1 3 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 13 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM SPEAKER SETUP Front speakers (A) Right Left Subwoofer system 1 Surround speakers Right Left 3 + – – 6 7 PREPARATION 2 SPEAKERS + + A + – – R L SURROUND B SUB WOOFER OUTPUT + + + – – R FRONT + – – L CENTER SURROUND BACK (U.S.A. model) Front speakers (B) 4 5 Center speaker Surround back speaker ■ FRONT terminals Connect one or two speaker systems to these terminals. If you use only one speaker system, connect it to either the FRONT A or B terminals. Note The Canada model cannot output to two separate speaker systems simultaneously. ■ CENTER terminals Connect a center speaker to these terminals. 4 2 1 6 3 7 5 ■ SURROUND terminals Connect surround speakers to these terminals. ■ SUB WOOFER jack Speaker layout English Connect a subwoofer with built-in amplifier, such as the YAMAHA Active Servo Processing Subwoofer System, to this jack. ■ SURROUND BACK terminals Connect a surround back speaker to these terminals. 13 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 14 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CONNECTIONS CONNECTIONS Before connecting components CAUTION Do not connect this unit or other components to the mains power until all connections between components are complete. Dust protection cap Pull out the cap from the optical jack before you connect the fiber optic cable. Do not discard the cap. When you are not using the optical jack, be sure to put the cap back in place. This cap protects the jack from dust. ■ Cable indications ■ Video jacks For analog signals left analog cables L right analog cables R For digital signals optical cables O coaxial cables C This unit has three types of video jacks. Connection depends on the availability of input jacks on your monitor. The signals input through the S VIDEO jacks on this unit are automatically converted for output through the VIDEO jacks. When V CONV. is set to ON (see page 50), signals input through the VIDEO jacks can be output through the S VIDEO jacks. For video signals video cables V S-Video cables S V V ■ Analog jacks S VIDEO VIDEO V You can input analog signals from audio components by connecting audio pin cable to the analog jacks on this unit. Connect red plugs to the right jacks and white plugs to the left jacks. ■ Digital jacks This unit has digital jacks for direct transmission of digital signals through either coaxial or fiber optic cables. You can use the digital jacks to input PCM, Dolby Digital and DTS bitstreams. When you connect components to both the COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks, priority is given to the input signals from the COAXIAL jack. All digital input jacks are compatible with 96-kHz sampling digital signals. Note This unit handles digital and analog signals independently. Thus audio signals input to the analog jacks are only output to the analog OUT (REC) jacks. Likewise audio signals input to the digital (OPTICAL or COAXIAL) jacks are only output to the DIGITAL OUTPUT jack. COMPONENT VIDEO PR PB Y VIDEO jack For conventional composite video signals. S VIDEO jack For S-Video signals, separated into luminance (Y) and color (C) video signals to achieve high-quality color reproduction. COMPONENT VIDEO jacks For component signals, separated into luminance (Y) and color difference (PB, PR) to provide the best quality in picture reproduction. Signal flow inside this unit Input Output (MONITOR OUT) COMPONENT VIDEO S VIDEO VIDEO Only when V CONV. is set to ON (see page 50). Note When signals are input through both the S VIDEO and VIDEO jacks, signals input through the S VIDEO jack have priority. 14 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 15 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CONNECTIONS Connecting video components ■ Connections for DVD playback Optical out Video out DVD player PREPARATION Audio out R O L COMPONENT VIDEO Y PB PR DVD AUDIO R VIDEO L VIDEO S VIDEO DVD MONITOR OUT Video in Video monitor DVD VIDEO S VIDEO MONITOR OUT (U.S.A. model) English 15 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 16 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CONNECTIONS ■ Connecting to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks This unit is equipped with 6 additional input jacks (left and right FRONT, CENTER, left and right SURROUND and SUB WOOFER) for discrete multi-channel input from a multi-format player, external decoder, sound processor or preamplifier. Connect the output jacks on your multi-format player or external decoder to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks. Be sure to match the left and right outputs to the left and right input jacks for the front and surround channels. (U.S.A. model) MULTI CH INPUT R L FRONT SURROUND CENTER SUB WOOFER R L Subwoofer out R L Center out Front out Multi-format player/ External decoder Surround out Notes • When you select MULTI CH INPUT as the input source, this unit automatically turns off the digital sound field processor, and you cannot select sound field programs. • This unit does not redirect signals input to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks to accommodate for missing speakers. We recommend that you connect at least a 5.1-channel speaker system before using this feature. • When headphones are used, only front left and right channels are output. 16 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 17 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CONNECTIONS ■ Connections for other video components Optical out Cable TV or satellite tuner Video out Audio out O R L (U.S.A. model) PREPARATION COMPONENT VIDEO PB Y PR AUDIO VIDEO L R VIDEO S VIDEO DTV /CBL DIGITAL INPUT COAXIAL DTV /CBL CD OPTICAL DTV/CBL IN VCR OUT R L R L Audio in Audio out Video in DVD recorder or VCR Video out ■ VIDEO AUX jacks (on the front panel) Use these jacks to connect any video source, such as a game console or video camera, to this unit. VIDEO AUX VIDEO L V L AUDIO R R Audio out R Game console or video camera Audio out L English Video out 17 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 18 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CONNECTIONS Connecting audio components ■ Connections for audio components DIGITAL INPUT COAXIAL Coaxial out CD C Audio out L CD player R CD MD/CD-R IN (PLAY) MD /CD-R (REC) L R AUDIO MD/CD-R OPTICAL DIGITAL OUTPUT (U.S.A. model) O O R L R L Audio out Optical in Optical out 18 Audio in MD recorder or tape deck 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 19 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CONNECTIONS Connecting the antennas Both AM and FM indoor antennas are included with this unit. In general, these antennas should provide sufficient signal strength. Connect each antenna correctly to the designated terminals. AM loop antenna (included) Indoor FM antenna (included) Notes • The AM loop antenna should be placed away from this unit. • The AM loop antenna should always be connected, even if an outdoor AM antenna is connected to this unit. • A properly installed outdoor antenna provides clearer reception than an indoor one. If you experience poor reception quality, an outdoor antenna may improve the quality. Consult the nearest authorized YAMAHA dealer or service center about outdoor antennas. PREPARATION ■ 75-ohm/300-ohm antenna adapter (U.K. model only) 1 Open the cover of the included 75-ohm/300-ohm antenna adapter. 2 Cut the external sleeve of the 75-ohm coaxial cable and prepare it for connection. TUNER AM ANT GND 75Ω UNBAL. FM ANT Ground (GND terminal) 3 For maximum safety and minimum interference, connect the antenna GND terminal to a good earth ground. A good earth ground is a metal stake driven into moist earth. ■ Connecting the AM loop antenna 1 4 Set up the AM loop antenna, then connect it to the terminals on this unit. 11 (7/16) 8 (5/16) 6 (1/14) Unit: mm (in.) Cut the lead wire and remove it. Insert the cable wire into the slot, and clamp it with pliers. Lead wire Clamp Clamp Insert wire into slot. 5 Snap the cover into place. ■ FREQUENCY STEP switch (Asia and General models only) Because the interstation frequency FREQUENCY STEP spacing differs in different areas, set AM FM the FREQUENCY STEP switch (locating on the rear panel) according to the frequency spacing in your area. • North, Central and South America: 100 kHz/10 kHz • Other areas: 50 kHz/9 kHz Before setting this switch, disconnect this unit’s power cord from the AC wall outlet. 10 KHZ / 100 KHZ Press and hold the tab to insert the AM loop antenna lead wires into the AM ANT and GND terminals. 3 Orient the AM loop antenna for the best reception. 9 KHZ / 50 KHZ 19 English 2 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 20 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CONNECTIONS Connecting the power supply cord ■ Connecting the AC power cord ■ Memory back-up Plug the power cord into an AC wall outlet. The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data from being lost even if this unit is in the standby mode. However if the power cord is disconnected from the AC wall outlet, or the power supply is cut for more than one week, the stored data will be lost. ■ AC OUTLET(S) (SWITCHED) U.K. and Australia models .............................. 1 OUTLET Korea model ...............................................................None Other models ..................................................2 OUTLETS Use these outlets to connect the power cords from your other components to this unit. Power to the AC OUTLET(S) is controlled by this unit’s STANDBY/ON (or SYSTEM POWER and STANDBY). The outlet(s) supply power to any connected component whenever this unit is turned on. The maximum power (total power consumption of components) that can be connected to the AC OUTLET(S) is: Asia and General models........................................... 50 W Korea model ................................................................ N/A Other models ...........................................................100 W ■ VOLTAGE SELECTOR (Asia and General models only) The VOLTAGE SELECTOR on the rear panel of this unit must be set for your local main voltage BEFORE plugging into the AC main supply. Voltages are: Asia model ..........................220/230-240 V AC, 50/60 Hz General model ......110/120/220/230-240 V AC, 50/60 Hz VOLTAGE SELECTOR VOLTAGE SELECTOR (Asia and General models) 20 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 21 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CONNECTIONS ■ IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch CAUTION Do not change the setting of the IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch when the unit power is switched on, as doing so may damage the unit. If this unit fails to turn on when STANDBY/ON is pressed on either the front panel or remote control, the IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch may not be fully slid to either position. If this is the case, slide the switch all the way to either position when this unit is in standby mode. IMPEDANCE SELECTOR SET BEFORE POWER ON PREPARATION Select the switch position (left or right) according to the impedance of the speakers in your system. IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch Switch position Speaker Impedance level If you use one set (A or B), the impedance of each speaker must be 4 Ω or higher. Front Left If you use two sets (A and B), the impedance of each speaker must be 8 Ω or higher. Center, Surround, Surround back The impedance of each speaker must be 6 Ω or higher. If you use one set (A or B), the impedance of each speaker must be 8 Ω or higher. Front If you use two sets (A and B), the impedance of each speaker must be 16 Ω or higher.* Right Center, Surround, Surround back * The impedance of each speaker must be 8 Ω or higher. The Canada model cannot use two separate speaker systems (A and B) simultaneously when the switch is set to the right position. English 21 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 22 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM CONNECTIONS Turning on the power When all connections are complete, turn on the power of this unit. (U.S.A. model) VOLUME PRESET/TUNING FM/AM EDIT A/B/C/D/E l PRESET/TUNING h NEXT LEVEL PROGRAM MEMORY TUNING MODE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO INPUT PHONES SPEAKERS A B STRAIGHT TONE CONTROL INPUT MODE MULTI CH INPUT STANDBY /ON VIDEO AUX EFFECT SILENT CINEMA VIDEO L AUDIO R 1 CODE SET TRANSMIT SYSTEM STANDBY POWER TV AV CD MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DVD DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN 1 AMP VCR 1 POWER POWER TV VOL TV CH TV MUTE TV INPUT VOLUME Press STANDBY/ON (SYSTEM POWER on the remote control) to turn on the power of this unit. SYSTEM POWER STANDBY /ON Front panel 2 22 or Remote control Turn on the video monitor connected to this unit. 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 23 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM BASIC SETUP BASIC SETUP The basic setup feature is a useful way to set up your system quickly and with minimal effort. 3 Press SELECT to enter BASIC SETUP. y PRESET/CH • If you wish to configure the unit manually using more precise adjustments, use the detailed parameters in SOUND MENU (page 47) instead of using BASIC SETUP. • Altering any parameters in BASIC SETUP will reset all parameters in SOUND MENU. SELECT Before you begin: • Press SPEAKERS A or B on the front panel to select the main speakers you want to use. • Make sure you disconnect your headphones from this unit. CODE SET TRANSMIT 1 2 3 4 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 9 0 The ROOM parameter appears in the front panel display. 4 POWER TV AV CD MD/CD-R STANDBY TUNER Select the size of the room you have installed your speakers in. Roughly speaking, the room sizes are defined as follows: POWER DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN ENTER EFFECT PRESET/CH LEVEL DVD 10 SLEEP TITLE SET MENU MENU A/B/C/D/E 1 SELECT AMP VCR TEST RETURN DISPLAY 2 3-13 [U.S.A. and Canada models] S (small) 16 x 13ft, 200ft2 (4.8 x 4.0m, 20m2) M (medium) 20 x 16ft, 300ft2 (6.3 x 5.0m, 30m2) L (large) 26 x 19ft, 450ft2 (7.9 x 5.8m, 45m2) REC AUDIO TV VOL TV CH VOLUME DISC SKIP FREQ/RDS TV MUTE 1 MODE PTY SEEK START EON TV INPUT [Other models] S (small) 3.6 x 2.8m, 10m2 M (medium) 4.8 x 4.0m, 20m2 L (large) 6.3 x 5.0m, 30m2 Press AMP. AMP 5 2 Press j / i to select the desired setting. ROOM: S M >L SYSTEM POWER Press d to display the SUBWOOFER parameter. Press SET MENU. “BASIC SETUP” appears in the front panel display. PRESET/CH SELECT SET MENU MENU A/B/C/D/E PREPARATION Using the BASIC SETUP menu BASIC SETUP 6 Press j / i to select the desired setting. SUBWOOFER YES YES NONE If you have a subwoofer in your system. If you do not have a subwoofer in your system. English 23 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 24 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM BASIC SETUP 7 Press d to display the SPEAKERS parameter. 11 Press SELECT to confirm your selection. PRESET/CH PRESET/CH SELECT SELECT 8 If you selected SET, you hear a test tone from each speaker in turn. “CHECK:Test Tone” appears in the front panel display for a few seconds, then “CHECK: OK?”. Press j / i to select the number of speakers you connected. CHECK:TestTone SPEAKERS 6spk Choices Display 2spk L C R SL SB SR 3spk L C R SL SB SR 4spk L C R SL SB SR 5spk L C R SL SB SR 6spk L C R SL SB SR Speakers CHECK OK? YES Front L/R Front L/R, Center 12 CHECK OK? YES Front L/R, Surround L/R YES Front L/R, Center, Surround L/R NO Front L/R, Center, Surround L/R, Surround back 13 9 Press j / i to select the desired setting. Press d to display SET/CANCEL. To complete the setup process if the test tone levels from each speaker were satisfactory. To proceed to the SP LEVEL speaker level adjustment menu to balance the level of each speaker. Press SELECT to confirm your selection. PRESET/CH PRESET/CH SELECT SELECT If you selected NO in step 12, the front speaker level adjustment display appears in the front panel display. 10 Press j / i to select the desired setting. >SET CANCEL SET CANCEL 24 To apply the settings you chose in steps 4 through 8. To cancel the setup without making any changes. 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 25 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM BASIC SETUP ■ To balance the speaker levels Perform the following steps after step 13 (see page 24). t 96 24 VCR SILENT CINEMA MATRIX DISCRETE VIRTUAL SP AB q DIGITAL q EX q PL q PL q PL x PCM V-AUX DTV/CBL DVD NIGHT ZONE2 SLEEP MD/CD-R PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER CD TUNED STEREO MEMORY MUTE VOLUME PTY RT CT EON FR-----||----- dB ft mS dB 96/24 L C R LFE SL SB SR The unit outputs the test tone from the selected speaker and the left front (or left surround) speaker in turn. The indicator of the speaker currently outputting the test tone flashes in the front panel display. Press d / u to select a speaker, then use j / i to adjust the balance. PREPARATION 1 Memory back-up The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data from being lost even if this unit is in the standby mode. However, if the power cord is disconnected from the AC outlet, or the power supply is cut for more than one week, the stored data will be lost. If so, adjust the items again. FR-----||----Adjusts the balance between the front left and right speakers. C-----||----Adjusts the balance between the front left and center speakers. SL-----||----Adjusts the balance between the front left and surround left speakers. SB-----||----Adjusts the balance between the surround left and surround back speakers. SR-----||----Adjusts the balance between the surround left and surround right speakers. SWFR-----||----Adjusts the balance between the front left speaker and the subwoofer. 2 Press SET MENU to exit after balancing the speakers. y You can also balance the speaker levels using test tone by pressing TEST on the remote control. English 25 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 26 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM PLAYBACK PLAYBACK Basic operations 4 (U.S.A. model) Select the input source. Use INPUT (or press one of the input selector buttons on the remote control) to select the input you desire. INPUT CD MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DVD DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN VOLUME or PRESET/TUNING FM/AM A/B/C/D/E l PRESET/TUNING h MEMORY TUNING MODE NEXT LEVEL MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO EDIT PROGRAM INPUT PHONES STRAIGHT SPEAKERS A B TONE CONTROL INPUT MODE MULTI CH INPUT STANDBY /ON AMP VCR VIDEO AUX EFFECT SILENT CINEMA VIDEO L AUDIO Front panel R Remote control 1 3 1 4 7 7 CODE SET 4 TRANSMIT SYSTEM POWER POWER TV AV STANDBY POWER CD MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DVD DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN TV CH TV VOL TV CH TV MUTE TV INPUT VOLUME 6 STEREO VOLUME HALL t 96 24 q EX q PL q PL q PL x PCM JAZZ VCR SILENT CINEMA MATRIX DISCRETE VIRTUAL SP AB q DIGITAL MUTE AMP VCR TV VOL The current input source name and input mode appear in the front panel display and video monitor for a few seconds. 6 V-AUX DTV/CBL DVD NIGHT ZONE2 SLEEP 10 DDVDD MD/CD-R TUNER PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS CD TUNED STEREO MEMORY MUTE VOLUME PTY RT CT EON AUTO00 dB ft mS dB 96/24 L C R LFE SL SB SR ROCK 1 2 3 4 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 9 0 10 ENTER 7 Selected input source Input mode EFFECT PRESET/CH 1 Start playback or select a broadcast station on the source component. Refer to the operating instructions for the component. 6 Adjust the volume to the desired output level. Press STANDBY/ON (SYSTEM POWER on the remote control) to turn on the power. SYSTEM POWER STANDBY /ON or Front panel Remote control 2 Turn on the video monitor connected to this unit. 3 Press SPEAKERS A or B on the front panel. Each press turns the respective speakers on or off. SPEAKERS B A 26 5 VOLUME or Front panel VOLUME Remote control 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 27 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM PLAYBACK 7 Select a sound field program if desired. Rotate PROGRAM (or press AMP on the remote control to select the AMP mode, then press one of the sound field program buttons repeatedly) to select a sound field program. (See page 40 for details about sound field programs.) To adjust the tone You can adjust the tonal quality TONE CONTROL of your front left and right speakers or headphones (when connected). Press TONE CONTROL on the front panel repeatedly to select TREBLE or BASS, then rotate PROGRAM to the right or left to increase or decrease. • Select TREBLE to adjust the high frequency response. • Select BASS to adjust the low frequency response. To cancel the tone control, press TONE CONTROL repeatedly to select BYPASS. PROGRAM PROGRAM AMP or Front panel STEREO HALL JAZZ 1 2 3 4 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 9 0 10 ROCK ENTER EFFECT To listen with headphones (SILENT CINEMA) “SILENT CINEMA” allows you to enjoy multi-channel music or movie sound, including Dolby Digital and DTS surround, through ordinary headphones. “SILENT CINEMA” activates automatically whenever you connect headphones to the PHONES jack while listening to CINEMA DSP or HiFi DSP sound field programs. When activated, the “SILENT CINEMA” indicator lights up in the front panel display. Notes • This unit will not be set to “SILENT CINEMA” when MULTI CH INPUT is selected as the input source. • “SILENT CINEMA” is not effective when the Direct Stereo or 2ch Stereo program is selected, or in STRAIGHT mode. Speaker and headphone adjustments are stored independently. Notes • If you increase or decrease the high-frequency or low-frequency sound to an extreme level, the tonal quality of the surround speakers may not match that of the front left and right speakers. • TONE CONTROL is not effective with the Direct Stereo program (page 31) or MULTI CH INPUT. To mute the sound Press MUTE on the remote control. The MUTE indicator blinks in the front panel display. To resume the audio output, press MUTE again (or press VOLUME –/+). The MUTE indicator disappears from the display. BASIC OPERATION Remote control y MUTE y You can adjust the muting level (see page 49). English 27 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 28 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM PLAYBACK ■ Selecting MULTI CH INPUT Press MULTI CH INPUT so that “MULTI CH INPUT” appears in the front panel display and video monitor. MULTI CH INPUT Selecting sound field programs ■ Front panel operation MULTI CH IN (U.S.A. model) or Front panel Remote control VOLUME PRESET/TUNING FM/AM A/B/C/D/E l PRESET/TUNING h NEXT LEVEL EDIT PROGRAM MEMORY TUNING MODE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO INPUT PHONES STRAIGHT SPEAKERS A B MULTI CH INPUT TONE CONTROL INPUT MODE MULTI CH INPUT STANDBY /ON VIDEO AUX EFFECT SILENT CINEMA VIDEO L AUDIO R Note When “MULTI CH INPUT” is shown in the front panel display, no other source can be played. To select another input source with INPUT (or one of the input selector buttons), press MULTI CH INPUT to turn off “MULTI CH INPUT” in the front panel display. PROGRAM Rotate PROGRAM to select the desired program. The name of the selected program appears in the front panel display and video monitor. ■ Playing video sources in the background PROGRAM You can combine a video image from a video source with sound from an audio source. For example, you can enjoy listening to classical music while viewing beautiful scenery from the video source on the video monitor. Use the input selector buttons on the remote control to select a video source, then select an audio source. CD MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DVD DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN Audio sources VCR AMP Video sources Note If you want to enjoy audio from the MULTI CH INPUT jacks together with a video source, first select the video source, then press MULTI CH INPUT. 28 t 96 24 VCR SILENT CINEMA MATRIX DISCRETE VIRTUAL SP AB q DIGITAL q EX q PL q PL q PL x PCM V-AUX DTV/CBL SLEEP MD/CD-R DVD NIGHT ZONE2 PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER EON 10 DJAZZACLUBO00 Program name CD TUNED STEREO MEMORY MUTE VOLUME PTY RT CT dB ft mS dB 96/24 L C R LFE SL SB SR 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 29 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM PLAYBACK ■ Remote control operation CODE SET TRANSMIT TV VOL TV CH ■ Enjoying multi-channel software If you connected a surround back speaker, use this feature to enjoy 6.1-channel playback for multi-channel sources using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx, Dolby Digital Surround EX or DTS-ES decoders. VOLUME SYSTEM POWER AMP POWER STANDBY POWER TV AV CD MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DVD DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN TV INPUT HALL JAZZ 1 2 3 4 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 9 0 MUTE AMP VCR TV MUTE STEREO ROCK 10 Sound field program buttons ENTER EFFECT TV VOL TV CH VOLUME LEVEL PRESET/CH SET MENU TITLE MENU Press AMP on the remote control to select the AMP mode, then press EX/ES to switch between 5.1 and 6.1-channel playback. A/B/C/D/E TV MUTE TV INPUT SELECT EX/ES AMP 10 Press AMP to select the AMP mode, then press one of the sound field program buttons repeatedly to select the desired program. The name of the selected program appears in the front panel display. To select a decoder, press j / i repeatedly while PLIIxMusic (etc.) is displayed. PRESET/CH STEREO AMP HALL JAZZ ROCK 2 3 4 ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 9 0 10 SELECT ENTER EFFECT t 96 24 VCR SILENT CINEMA MATRIX DISCRETE VIRTUAL SP AB q DIGITAL q EX q PL q PL q PL x PCM V-AUX DTV/CBL SLEEP MD/CD-R DVD NIGHT ZONE2 PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER CD TUNED STEREO MEMORY MUTE VOLUME PTY RT CT EON 10 DJAZZACLUBO00 dB ft mS dB 96/24 L C R LFE SL SB SR Program name y Feel free to choose a sound field program based on your listening preference, and not purely on the name of the program itself. Notes • When you select an input source, this unit automatically selects the last sound field program used with that source. • Sound field programs cannot be selected when MULTI CH INPUT is selected. • Sampling frequencies higher than 48 kHz (except for DTS 96/ 24 signals) will be sampled down to 48 kHz, then sound field programs will be applied. AUTO (AUTO) When a signal (flag) that can be recognized by the unit is input, the unit selects the optimum decoder for playing back the signal in 6.1 channels. If the unit cannot recognize the flag or no flag is present in the input signal, it cannot automatically be played in 6.1 channels. BASIC OPERATION 1 MUSIC Decoders (select with j / i) You can select from the following decoders depending on the format of the software you are playing. PLIIxMusic For playing back Dolby Digital or DTS signals in 6.1 channels using the Pro Logic IIx music decoder. EX/ES For playing back Dolby Digital signals in 6.1 channels using the Dolby Digital Surround EX decoder. DTS signals are played back in 6.1 channels using the DTS-ES decoder. EX For playing back Dolby Digital or DTS signals in 6.1 channels using the Dolby Digital Surround EX decoder. OFF (OFF) Decoders are not used to create 6.1 channels. English 29 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 30 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM PLAYBACK Notes • Some 6.1-channel compatible discs do not have a signal (flag) which this unit can automatically detect. When playing these kinds of discs with 6.1-channel, select a decoder manually (PLIIx Music, EX/ES or EX). • 6.1-channel playback is not possible even if EX/ES is pressed in the following cases: – When “SURR LR” (see page 47) or “SURR B” (see page 47) is set to NONE. – When the source connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jack is being played. – When the source being played does not contain surround left and right channel signals. – When a Dolby Digital KARAOKE source is being played. – When “2ch Stereo” or “Direct Stereo” is selected. • When the power of this unit is turned off, the input mode will be reset to AUTO. • When the DTS-ES decoder is applied to DTS 96/24 signals, you cannot use the DTS 96/24 decoding feature. • The Pro Logic IIx decoder is not available when “SURR B” is set to NONE (see page 47). ■ Enjoying 2-channel software Signals input from 2-channel sources can also be played back on multiple channels. Press q/DTS on the remote control to select the decoder. q/DTS 9 You can select from the following decoders depending on the type of software you are playing and your personal preference. PRO LOGIC SUR. STANDARD Standard processing for Dolby Surround sources. PRO LOGIC SUR. ENHANCED CINEMA DSP enhanced processing for Dolby Surround sources. PRO LOGIC IIx Movie* Dolby Pro Logic II/IIx processing for movie software. PRO LOGIC IIx Music* Dolby Pro Logic II/IIx processing for music software. PRO LOGIC IIx Game* Dolby Pro Logic II/IIx processing for game software. DTS Neo:6 Cinema DTS processing for movie software. DTS Neo:6 Music DTS processing for music software. * Use the PLII/PLIIx parameter to select the Pro Logic II or Pro Logic IIx decoders (see page 41). Note The Pro Logic IIx decoder is not available when “SURR B” is set to NONE (see page 47). 30 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 31 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM PLAYBACK ■ Listening to high fidelity stereo sound (Direct Stereo) Direct Stereo allows you to bypass this unit’s decoders and DSP processors to enjoy pure high fidelity sound from 2channel PCM and analog sources. Rotate PROGRAM (or press AMP to select the AMP mode, then press STEREO repeatedly) to select “Direct Stereo”. PROGRAM ■ Night listening modes The night listening modes are designed to improve listenability at lower volumes or at night. Choose either NIGHT:CINEMA or NIGHT:MUSIC depending on the type of material you are playing. Press NIGHT on the remote control repeatedly to select cinema or music. When night listening is selected, the NIGHT indicator in the front panel display lights up. AMP NIGHT or 0 Remote control Front panel HALL JAZZ ROCK 1 2 3 4 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 9 0 10 ENTER EFFECT Remote control • Select NIGHT:CINEMA when watching films to reduce the dynamic range of film soundtracks and make dialog easier to hear at lower volumes. • Select NIGHT:MUSIC when listening to music sources to preserve ease-of-listening for all sounds. • Select OFF if you do not want to use this function. Press j / i to adjust the effect level while NIGHT:CINEMA or NIGHT:MUSIC is displayed. This adjusts the level of compression. Direct Stereo BASIC OPERATION STEREO PRESET/CH Notes • To avoid unexpected noise, do not play DTS-encoded CDs in this mode. • When multi-channel signals (Dolby Digital and DTS) are input, this unit automatically switches to the corresponding analog input. (When DTS is selected as an input mode, no sound will be heard.) • No sound will be output from the subwoofer. • TONE CONTROL (page 27) and SET MENU (page 45) settings are not effective. • The front panel display automatically dims. SELECT Remote control Effect.Lvl:MID • Select MIN for minimum compression. • Select MID for standard compression. • Select MAX for maximum compression. y NIGHT:CINEMA and NIGHT:MUSIC adjustments are stored independently. Notes • You cannot use the night listening modes with the Direct Stereo program or MULTI CH INPUT (even though the NIGHT indicator lights up when Direct Stereo is selected). • The night listening modes may vary in effectiveness depending on the input source and surround sound settings you use. English 31 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 32 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM PLAYBACK ■ Downmixing to 2 channels You can enjoy 2-channel stereo playback even from multichannel sources. Rotate PROGRAM (or press STEREO on the remote control) to select 2ch Stereo. Selecting input modes This unit comes with a variety of input jacks. Do the following to select the type of input signals you want to use. PROGRAM or STEREO HALL JAZZ 1 2 3 ROCK 4 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 9 0 10 1 Rotate INPUT to select the input source. INPUT ENTER EFFECT Front panel Remote control 2 2ch Stereo Press INPUT MODE to select an input mode. In most cases, use AUTO. y INPUT MODE You can use a subwoofer with this program when SWFR or BOTH is selected in “BASS OUT”. ■ Listening to unprocessed input signals In STRAIGHT mode, two channel stereo sources are output from only the front left and right speakers. Multichannel sources are decoded straight into the appropriate channels without any additional effect processing. t 96 24 q EX q PL q PL q PL x PCM Press STRAIGHT (EFFECT) to select STRAIGHT. STRAIGHT VCR SILENT CINEMA MATRIX DISCRETE VIRTUAL SP AB q DIGITAL V-AUX SLEEP 10 DDVDD Input source STRAIGHT DTV/CBL DVD NIGHT ZONE2 MD/CD-R PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER CD TUNED STEREO MEMORY MUTE VOLUME PTY RT CT EON AUTO00 dB ft mS dB 96/24 L C R LFE SL SB SR Input mode ENTER EFFECT or Front panel AUTO EFFECT Remote control DTS STRAIGHT ANALOG Press STRAIGHT (EFFECT) again so that “STRAIGHT” disappears from the display when you want to turn the sound effect back on. * If this unit detects a Dolby Digital or DTS signal, the decoder automatically switches to the appropriate sound field program. ■ Virtual CINEMA DSP Virtual CINEMA DSP allows you to enjoy the CINEMA DSP programs without surround speakers. It creates virtual speakers to reproduce the natural sound field. If you do not connect surround speakers, Virtual CINEMA DSP activates automatically whenever you select a CINEMA DSP sound field program. Note Virtual CINEMA DSP will not activate, even when “SURR LR” is set to NONE (see page 47) in the following cases: – When MULTI CH INPUT is selected as the input source. – When headphones are connected to the PHONES jack. 32 Automatically selects input signals in the following order: 1) Digital signals* 2) Analog signals Selects only digital signals encoded in DTS. If no DTS signals are input, no sound is output. Selects only analog signals. If no analog signals are input, no sound is output. y You can adjust the default input mode this unit selects when the power is turned on (see page 49). 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 33 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM PLAYBACK Notes 3 • When you play DTS-encoded CD/LDs with the input mode set to AUTO: – This unit automatically switches to the DTS decoding mode. The unit remains in DTS mode (and the t indicator may flash) for up to 30 seconds after playback of the DTS source is complete. To manually release the DTS mode, press INPUT MODE to reselect AUTO. – The DTS decoding mode may be released if search or skip operations are performed for more than 30 seconds. To prevent this, press INPUT MODE to select DTS. • If the digital output data of the player has been processed in any way, you may not be able to perform DTS decoding even if you make a digital connection between this unit and the player. Displaying the information about the input source Press u / d to display the following information about the input signal. PRESET/CH SELECT (Format) in You can display the type, format and sampling frequency of the current input signal. 1 fs Select the input source. MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DVD DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN AMP VCR 2 rate flg BASIC OPERATION CD Signal format display. When the unit cannot detect a digital signal it automatically switches to analog input. Number of source channels in the input signal. For example, a multi-channel soundtrack with 3 front channels, 2 surround channels and LFE, is displayed as “3/2/LFE”. Sampling frequency. When the unit is unable to detect the sampling frequency “Unknown” appears. Bit rate. When the unit is unable to detect the bit rate “Unknown” appears. Flag data encoded with DTS or Dolby Digital signals that cue this unit to automatically switch decoders. Press AMP to select the AMP mode, then press STRAIGHT (EFFECT) so that “STRAIGHT” appears in the display. STRAIGHT AMP then ENTER EFFECT STRAIGHT English 33 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 34 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM TUNING TUNING Automatic and manual tuning 3 There are 2 tuning methods; automatic and manual. Automatic tuning is effective when station signals are strong and there is no interference. TUNING MODE ■ Automatic tuning FM/AM A/B/C/D/E l PRESET/TUNING h NEXT LEVEL PROGRAM MEMORY TUNING MODE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO Lights up If a colon (:) appears in the front panel display, tuning is not possible. Press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) to turn the colon (:) off. VOLUME EDIT AUTO AUTO/MAN'L MONO (U.S.A. model) PRESET/TUNING Press TUNING MODE (AUTO/MAN’L MONO) so that the AUTO indicator lights up in the front panel display. PRESET/TUNING INPUT PHONES SPEAKERS A B STRAIGHT TONE CONTROL INPUT MODE MULTI CH INPUT EDIT STANDBY /ON VIDEO AUX EFFECT SILENT CINEMA VIDEO 3 2 1 4 1 L AUDIO R 3 VCR T CINEMA SP TUAL V-AUX DTV/CBL MD/CD-R DVD NIGHT ZONE2 AB PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP SLEEP PS TUNER TUNED STEREO MEM PTY RT CT EON 1A -AAM11440kkHz Rotate INPUT to select TUNER as the input source. INPUT 4 Press PRESET/TUNING l / h once to begin automatic tuning. Press h to tune into a higher frequency, or press l to tune into a lower frequency. l PRESET/TUNING h Front panel 2 LEVEL Press FM/AM to select the reception band. “FM” or “AM” appears in the front panel display. VCR T CINEMA SP TUAL AB FM/AM FM or AM V-AUX DTV/CBL DVD NIGHT ZONE2 SLEEP MD/CD-R PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER TUNED STEREO MEM PTY RT CT EON 1A -AAM11530kkHz When tuned into a station, the TUNED indicator lights up and the frequency of the received station is shown in the front panel display. 34 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 35 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM TUNING ■ Manual tuning If the signal from the station you want to select is weak, tune into it manually. Manually tuning into an FM station will automatically switch the tuner to monaural reception to increase the signal quality. 1 Select TUNER and the reception band following steps 1 and 2 as described in “Automatic tuning”. 2 Press TUNING MODE (AUTO/MAN’L MONO) so that the AUTO indicator disappears from the front panel display. Presetting stations ■ Automatically presetting FM stations You can use the automatic preset tuning feature to store FM stations. This function enables this unit to automatically tune into FM stations with strong signals, and to store up to 40 (8 stations in 5 groups, A1 through E8) of those stations in order. You can then recall any preset station easily by selecting the preset station number. (U.S.A. model) VOLUME PRESET/TUNING TUNING MODE l PRESET/TUNING h A/B/C/D/E NEXT LEVEL PROGRAM MEMORY TUNING MODE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO INPUT PHONES STRAIGHT SPEAKERS A B TONE CONTROL INPUT MODE MULTI CH INPUT STANDBY /ON Disappears AUTO/MAN'L MONO FM/AM EDIT AUTO VIDEO AUX EFFECT SILENT CINEMA VIDEO 1 1 PRESET/TUNING VCR T CINEMA SP TUAL AB V-AUX DTV/CBL DVD NIGHT ZONE2 SLEEP MD/CD-R PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER TUNED STEREO MEM PTY RT CT EON 1A -AAM11440kkHz 3 Press PRESET/TUNING l / h to tune into the desired station manually. Hold down the button to l PRESET/TUNING h continue searching. LEVEL 2 R 3 2 Press FM/AM to select the FM band. FM/AM EDIT AUDIO BASIC OPERATION If a colon (:) appears in the front panel display, tuning is not possible. Press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) to turn the colon (:) off. L FM Press TUNING MODE (AUTO/MAN’L MONO) so that the AUTO indicator lights up in the front panel display. TUNING MODE AUTO Lights up AUTO/MAN'L MONO If a colon (:) appears in the front panel display, tuning is not possible. Press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) to turn the colon (:) off. PRESET/TUNING EDIT VCR T CINEMA SP TUAL AB V-AUX DTV/CBL DVD NIGHT ZONE2 SLEEP MD/CD-R PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER TUNED STEREO MEM PTY RT CT EON 1A -AAM11440kkHz English 35 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 36 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM TUNING ■ Manually presetting stations 3 Press and hold MEMORY (MAN’L/AUTO FM) for more than 3 seconds. The preset number, the MEMORY and AUTO indicators flash. After about 5 seconds, automatic presetting starts from the frequency currently displayed and proceeds toward the higher frequencies. You can also store up to 40 stations (8 stations x 5 groups) manually. (U.S.A. model) VOLUME PRESET/TUNING FM/AM A/B/C/D/E l PRESET/TUNING h NEXT LEVEL EDIT PROGRAM MEMORY MEMORY TUNING MODE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO INPUT PHONES STRAIGHT SPEAKERS A B TONE CONTROL INPUT MODE MULTI CH INPUT STANDBY /ON VIDEO AUX EFFECT SILENT CINEMA MAN'L/AUTO FM t 96 24 VCR SILENT CINEMA MATRIX DISCRETE VIRTUAL SP AB q DIGITAL q EX q PL q PL q PL x PCM V-AUX DTV/CBL DVD NIGHT ZONE2 SLEEP VIDEO MD/CD-R PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER 3 4 CD L AUDIO R 2,5 TUNED STEREO MEMORY MUTE VOLUME PTY RT CT EON 1A 1:FM187.5kMHz dB ft mS dB 96/24 L C R LFE SL SB SR 1 When automatic preset tuning is completed, the front panel display shows the frequency of the last preset station. Tune into a station. See page 34 for tuning instructions. t 96 24 q EX q PL VCR SILENT CINEMA MATRIX DISCRETE VIRTUAL SP AB q DIGITAL q PL q PL x PCM V-AUX DTV/CBL DVD NIGHT ZONE2 SLEEP MD/CD-R PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER CD TUNED STEREO MEMORY MUTE VOLUME PTY RT CT EON 1A 1:AM18630kkHz dB ft mS dB 96/24 L C R LFE SL SB SR Notes • Any stored station data existing under a preset number is cleared when you store a new station under that preset number. • If the number of the received stations does not reach 40 (E8), automatic preset tuning has automatically stopped after searching all stations. • Only FM stations with sufficient signal strength are stored automatically by automatic preset tuning. If the station you want to store is weak in signal strength, tune into it manually and store it by following the procedure in “Manually presetting stations”. When tuned into a station, the front panel display shows the frequency of the station received. 2 Press MEMORY (MAN’L/AUTO FM). The MEMORY indicator flashes for about 5 seconds. MEMORY MEMORY MAN'L/AUTO FM Flashes Automatic preset tuning options You can select the preset number from which this unit will store FM stations and/or begin tuning toward lower frequencies. After pressing MEMORY in step 3: 1 Press A/B/C/D/E, then PRESET/TUNING l / h to select the preset number under which the first station will be stored. Automatic preset tuning will stop when stations have all been stored up to E8. 2 Press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) to turn off the colon (:) and then press PRESET/TUNING l to begin tuning toward the lower frequencies. Memory back-up The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data from being lost even if this unit is set in the standby mode, the power cord is disconnected from the AC outlet, or the power supply is temporarily cut due to power failure. However, if the power is cut for more than one week, the preset stations may be cleared. If so, store the stations again by using the presetting station methods. 36 3 Press A/B/C/D/E repeatedly to select a preset station group (A to E) while the MEMORY indicator is flashing. The group letter appears. Check that the colon (:) appears in the front panel display. A/B/C/D/E NEXT t 96 24 VCR SILENT CINEMA MATRIX DISCRETE VIRTUAL SP AB q DIGITAL q EX q PL q PL q PL x PCM V-AUX DTV/CBL DVD NIGHT ZONE2 SLEEP MD/CD-R PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER EON 1C 1:AM18630kkHz Preset group CD TUNED STEREO MEMORY MUTE VOLUME PTY RT CT dB ft mS dB 96/24 L C R LFE SL SB SR 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 37 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM TUNING 4 Press PRESET/TUNING l / h to select a preset station number (1 through 8) while the MEMORY indicator is flashing. Press h to select a higher preset station number. Press l to select a lower preset station number. Selecting preset stations You can tune any desired station simply by selecting the preset station number under which it was stored. (U.S.A. model) l PRESET/TUNING h VOLUME LEVEL PRESET/TUNING FM/AM l PRESET/TUNING h A/B/C/D/E NEXT EDIT LEVEL PROGRAM MEMORY TUNING MODE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO INPUT PHONES STRAIGHT SPEAKERS A B TONE CONTROL INPUT MODE MULTI CH INPUT STANDBY /ON VIDEO AUX EFFECT SILENT CINEMA VIDEO t 96 24 VCR SILENT CINEMA MATRIX DISCRETE VIRTUAL SP AB q DIGITAL q EX q PL q PL q PL x PCM V-AUX DTV/CBL DVD NIGHT ZONE2 SLEEP MD/CD-R PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER L AUDIO R CD TUNED STEREO MEMORY MUTE VOLUME PTY RT CT EON 1C 3:AM18630kkHz dB ft mS dB 96/24 L C R LFE SL SB SR 1 2 Preset number q/DTS NIGHT 9 0 EX/ES STRAIGHT 10 ENTER EFFECT LEVEL PRESET/CH 5 1 2 SET MENU TITLE MENU A/B/C/D/E MAN'L/AUTO FM t 96 24 VCR SILENT CINEMA MATRIX DISCRETE VIRTUAL SP AB q DIGITAL q EX q PL q PL q PL x PCM V-AUX DTV/CBL DVD NIGHT ZONE2 SLEEP MD/CD-R PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER SELECT TEST RETURN AUDIO When performing this operation with the remote control, first press TUNER to set the remote to tuner mode. 1 CD TUNED STEREO MEMORY MUTE VOLUME PTY RT CT EON 1C 3:AM18630kkHz dB ft mS dB 96/24 DISPLAY REC L C R LFE SL SB SR Shows the displayed station has been stored as C3. Press A/B/C/D/E to select the preset station group. The preset group letter appears in the front panel display and changes each time you press the button. A/B/C/D/E SET MENU or 6 BASIC OPERATION Press MEMORY (MAN’L/AUTO FM) on the front panel while the MEMORY indicator is flashing. The station band and MEMORY frequency appear in the front panel display with the preset group and number you have selected. MENU NEXT A/B/C/D/E Repeat steps 1 to 5 to store other stations. Front panel Remote control Notes • Any stored station data existing under a preset number is cleared when you store a new station under that preset number. • The reception mode (stereo or monaural) is stored along with the station frequency. 2 Press PRESET/TUNING l / h (PRESET/CH u / d on the remote control) to select a preset station number (1 to 8). The preset group and number appear in the front panel display along with the station band, frequency and the TUNED indicator lights up. PRESET/CH l PRESET/TUNING h or SELECT LEVEL Front panel Remote control AB x V-AUX DTV/CBL DVD NIGHT ZONE2 SLEEP MD/CD-R PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER English VCR SILENT CINEMA SP VIRTUAL CD TUNED STEREO MEMORY M PTY RT CT EON 1E 1:FM187.5kMHz ft mS dB 9 37 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 38 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM TUNING Exchanging preset stations 4 You can exchange the assignment of two preset stations with each other. The example below describes the procedure for exchanging preset station “E1” with “A5”. Press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) again. The stations stored at the two preset assignments are exchanged. PRESET/TUNING EDIT (U.S.A. model) VOLUME VCR PRESET/TUNING FM/AM A/B/C/D/E l PRESET/TUNING h MEMORY TUNING MODE NEXT LEVEL MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO SILENT CINEMA SP VIRTUAL AB EDIT PROGRAM INPUT x PHONES STRAIGHT SPEAKERS A B TONE CONTROL INPUT MODE MULTI CH INPUT STANDBY /ON VIDEO AUX EFFECT SILENT CINEMA VIDEO 2,4 L AUDIO R 1,3 1,3 1 Select preset station “E1” using A/B/C/D/E and PRESET/TUNING l / h. See “Selecting preset stations”. 2 Press and hold PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) for more than 3 seconds. “E1” and the MEMORY indicator flash in the front panel display. PRESET/TUNING EDIT VCR SILENT CINEMA SP VIRTUAL x 3 SLEEP DTV/CBL DVD MD/CD-R PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER CD TUNED STEREO MEMORY M PTY RT CT EON 1E 1:FM187.5kMHz ft mS dB 9 Select preset station “A5” using A/B/C/D/E and PRESET/TUNING l / h. “A5” and the MEMORY indicator flash in the front panel display. A/B/C/D/E l PRESET/TUNING h NEXT LEVEL VCR SILENT CINEMA SP VIRTUAL AB x 38 V-AUX NIGHT ZONE2 AB V-AUX DTV/CBL DVD NIGHT ZONE2 SLEEP MD/CD-R PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER CD TUNED STEREO MEMORY M PTY RT CT EON 1A 5:FM190.6kMHz ft mS dB 9 V-AUX DTV/CBL DVD NIGHT ZONE2 SLEEP MD/CD-R PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER CD TUNED STEREO MEMORY M PTY RT CT EON 1E EDIT18E1-A5Hz ft mS dB 9 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 39 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM RECORDING RECORDING Recording adjustments and other operations are performed from the recording components. Refer to the operating instructions for those components. (U.S.A. model) VOLUME PRESET/TUNING FM/AM l PRESET/TUNING h A/B/C/D/E NEXT EDIT LEVEL PROGRAM MEMORY TUNING MODE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO INPUT PHONES SPEAKERS A B STRAIGHT TONE CONTROL INPUT MODE MULTI CH INPUT STANDBY /ON VIDEO AUX EFFECT SILENT CINEMA VIDEO 1 L AUDIO R 2 CODE SET TRANSMIT SYSTEM POWER POWER TV AV CD MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DVD DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN 1 AMP VCR TV VOL TV CH TV MUTE TV INPUT VOLUME 1 Turn on the power of this unit and all connected components. 2 Select the source component you want to record from. INPUT or CD MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DVD DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN VCR Front panel AMP Remote control 3 Start playback (or select a broadcast station) on the source component. 4 Start recording on the recording component. BASIC OPERATION 2 STANDBY POWER Notes • When this unit is set in the standby mode, you cannot record between other components connected to this unit. • The setting of TONE CONTROL, VOLUME, “SP LEVEL” (page 48) and the sound field programs does not affect recorded material. • A source connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks of this unit cannot be recorded. • S-Video and composite video signals pass independently through this unit’s video circuits. Therefore, when recording or dubbing video signals, if your video source component is connected to provide only an S-Video (or only a composite video) signal, you can record only an S-Video (or only a composite video) signal to your VCR. • Digital signals input to the DIGITAL INPUT jacks are not output to the analog AUDIO OUT (L/R) jacks for recording. Likewise, analog signals input to the AUDIO IN (L/R) jacks are not output to the DIGITAL OUTPUT jack. Therefore, if your source component is connnected to provide only digital (or analog) signals, you can only record digital (or analog) signals. • A given input source is not output on the same REC OUT channel. (For example, the signal input from VCR IN is not output on VCR OUT.) • Check the copyright laws in your country to record from records, CDs, radio, etc. Recording of copyrighted material may infringe copyright laws. If you playback a video source that uses scrambled or encoded signals to prevent it from being dubbed, the picture itself may be disturbed due to those signals. ■ Special considerations when recording DTS software The DTS signal is a digital bitstream. Attempting to digitally record the DTS bitstream will result in noise being recorded. Therefore, if you want to use this unit to record sources that have DTS signals recorded on them, the following considerations and adjustments need to be made. For DVDs and CDs encoded with DTS, when your player is compatible with the DTS format, follow its operating instructions to make a setting so that the analog signal will be output from the player. y Do a test recording before you start an actual recording. English 39 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 40 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM SOUND FIELD PROGRAM DESCRIPTIONS SOUND FIELD PROGRAM DESCRIPTIONS This unit is equipped with a variety of precise digital decoders that allow you to enjoy multichannel playback from almost any sound source (stereo or multichannel). This unit is also equipped with a YAMAHA digital sound field processing (DSP) chip containing several sound field programs which you can use to enhance your playback experience. Most of these sound field programs are precise digital recreations of actual acoustic environments found in famous concert halls, music venues, and movie theaters. y The YAMAHA CINEMA DSP modes are compatible with all Dolby Digital, DTS, and Dolby Surround sources. Set the input mode to AUTO (see page 32) to enable this unit to automatically switch to the appropriate digital decoder according to the input signal. Notes • This unit’s DSP sound field programs are recreations of real-world acoustic environments made from precise measurements taken in the actual hall, etc. Thus you may notice variations in the strength of the reflections coming from the front, back, left and right. • Feel free to choose a sound field program based on your listening preference, and not purely on the name of the program itself. For movie/video sources You can select from the following sound fields when playing movie or video sources. The sound fields marked “MULTI” can be used with multi-channel sources, like DVD, digital TV, etc. Those marked “2-CH” can be used with 2-channel (stereo) sources like TV programs, video tapes, etc. Program Features STEREO: 2ch Stereo Downmixes multi-channel sources to 2 channels (left and right) or plays back 2-channel sources as is. MUSIC VIDEO This program lends an enthusiastic atmosphere to the sound, giving you the feeling you are at an actual jazz or rock concert. ENTERTAINMENT: Game This program adds a deep and spatial feeling to video game sounds. TV THEATER: Mono Movie This program is provided for reproducing monaural video sources (such as old movies). The program produces the optimum reverberation to create sound depth using only the presernce sound field. TV THEATER: Variety/Sports Though the presence sound field is relatively narrow, the surround sound field employs the sound environment of a large concert hall. This effect enhances the experience of watching various TV programs such as news, variety shows, music programs or sports programs. MOVIE THEATER: Spectacle CINEMA DSP processing. This program creates the extremely wide sound field of a 70-mm movie theater. It precisely reproduces the source sound in detail, making both the video and the sound field incredibly real. This is ideal for any kind of video source encoded with Dolby Surround, Dolby Digital or DTS (especially large-scale movie productions). MOVIE THEATER: Sci-Fi CINEMA DSP processing. This program clearly reproduces dialog and sound effects in the latest sound form for science fiction films, thus creating a broad and expansive cinematic space amid silence. You can enjoy science fiction films in a virtual-space sound field that includes Dolby Surround, Dolby Digital and DTS-encoded software employing the most advanced techniques. MOVIE THEATER: Adventure CINEMA DSP processing. This program is ideal for precisely reproducing the sound design of the newest 70-mm and multichannel soundtrack films. The sound field is made to be similar to that of the newest movie theaters, so the reverberations of the sound field itself are restrained as much as possible. MOVIE THEATER: General CINEMA DSP processing. This program is for reproducing sounds from 70-mm and multichannel soundtrack films, and is characterized by soft and extensive sound field. 40 Sources MULTI 2-CH 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 41 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM SOUND FIELD PROGRAM DESCRIPTIONS Program Features Standard 5.1-channel processing for Dolby Digital sources. DOLBY DIGITAL: SUR. ENHANCED CINEMA DSP enhanced processing for Dolby Digital sources. DOLBY D EX: SUR. STANDARD Standard 6.1-channel processing for Dolby Digital sources. DOLBY D EX: SUR. ENHANCED CINEMA DSP enhanced 6.1-channel processing (Dolby Digital EX) for Dolby Digital sources. DTS: SUR. STANDARD Standard 5.1-channel processing for DTS sources. DTS 96/24: SUR. STANDARD Standard 5.1-channel processing for 96-kHz/24-bit DTS sources. DTS: SUR. ENHANCED CINEMA DSP enhanced processing for DTS and 96-kHz/24-bit DTS sources. DTS+DOLBY EX: SUR. STANDARD Standard 6.1-channel processing (Dolby Digital EX) for DTS sources. DTS+DOLBY EX: SUR. ENHANCED CINEMA DSP enhanced 6.1-channel processing (Dolby Digital EX) for DTS sources. DTS ES Mtrx6.1: SUR. STANDARD Standard 6.1-channel processing (DTS-ES Matrix) for DTS sources. DTS ES Mtrx6.1: SUR. ENHANCED CINEMA DSP enhanced processing (DTS-ES Matrix) for DTS sources. DTS ES Disc6.1: SUR. STANDARD Standard 6.1-channel processing (DTS-ES Discrete) for DTS sources. DTS ES Disc6.1: SUR. ENHANCED CINEMA DSP enhanced processing (DTS-ES Discrete) for DTS sources. PRO LOGIC: SUR. STANDARD Standard processing for Dolby Surround sources. PRO LOGIC: SUR. ENHANCED CINEMA DSP enhanced processing for Dolby Surround sources. PRO LOGIC IIx: PLIIx Movie Dolby Pro Logic IIx processing for movie software.* PRO LOGIC II: PLII Movie Dolby Pro Logic II processing for movie software.* PRO LOGIC IIx: PLIIx Game Dolby Pro Logic IIx processing for game software.* PRO LOGIC II: PLII Game Dolby Pro Logic II processing for game software.* DTS: Neo:6 Cinema DTS processing for movie software. * You can select either Pro Logic IIx or Pro MULTI SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS DOLBY DIGITAL: SUR. STANDARD Sources 2-CH Logic II processing using the PLII/PLIIx parameter on page 61. English 41 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 42 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM SOUND FIELD PROGRAM DESCRIPTIONS For music sources You can select from the following sound fields when playing music sources, like CD, FM/AM broadcasting, tapes, etc. Program Features CONCERT HALL HiFi DSP processing. A classic shoe-box type concert hall with approximately 1700 seats. Pillars and ornate carvings create extremely complex reflections which produce a very full, rich sound. JAZZ CLUB HiFi DSP processing. This is the sound field at stage front in “The Bottom Line”, a famous New York jazz club. The floor can seat 300 people to the left and right in a sound field offering a real and vibrant sound. ROCK CONCERT HiFi DSP processing. The ideal program for lively, dynamic rock music. The data for this program was recorded at LA’s “hottest” rock club. The listener’s virtual seat is at the centerleft of the hall. ENTERTAINMENT: Disco HiFi DSP processing. This program recreates the acoustic environment of a lively disco in the heart of a big city. The sound is dense and highly concentrated. It is also characterized by highenergy, “immediate” sound. q D+PLIIx Music: SUR. STANDARD Standard Dolby Digital and Dolby Pro Logic IIx processing for music sources. q D+PLIIx Music: SUR. ENHANCED CINEMA DSP enhanced Dolby Digital and Dolby Pro Logic IIx processing for music sources. DTS+PLIIx Music: SUR. STANDARD Standard DTS and Dolby Pro Logic IIx processing for music sources. DTS+PLIIx Music: SUR. ENHANCED CINEMA DSP enhanced DTS and Dolby Pro Logic IIx processing for music sources. STEREO: 2ch Stereo 2-channel (left and right) playback. STEREO: Direct Stereo Use to output stereo sources to only the front left and right speakers without any processing. STEREO: 6ch Stereo Use to increase the output stereo sources (in stereo) from all speakers. This provides a larger sound field and is ideal for background music at parties, etc. PRO LOGIC IIx: PLIIx Music Dolby Pro Logic IIx processing for music software.* PRO LOGIC II: PLII Music Dolby Pro Logic II processing for music software.* DTS: Neo:6 Music DTS processing for music software. MULTI 2-CH MULTI * You can select either Pro Logic IIx or Pro 42 Sources Logic II processing using the PLII/PLIIx parameter on page 61. 2-CH 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 43 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM ADVANCED OPERATIONS ADVANCED OPERATIONS ■ Canceling the sleep timer Using the sleep timer Use this feature to automatically set this unit in the standby mode after a certain amount of time. The sleep timer is useful when you are going to sleep while this unit is playing or recording a source. The sleep timer also automatically turns off any external components connected to the AC OUTLET(S). STANDBY POWER POWER TV AV CD MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DVD DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN 2 AMP VCR TV VOL TV CH TV MUTE TV INPUT VOLUME 1 Select a source and start playback on the source component. 2 Press SLEEP repeatedly to set the amount of time. Each time you press SLEEP, the front panel display changes as shown below. The SLEEP indicator flashes while switching the amount of time for the sleep timer. SLEEP 120min t 96 24 q EX q PL q PL q PL x PCM SLEEP 90min SLEEP 30min VCR SILENT CINEMA MATRIX DISCRETE VIRTUAL SP AB q DIGITAL V-AUX DTV/CBL DVD NIGHT ZONE2 SLEEP SLEEP SLEEP 60min MD/CD-R PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER ADVANCED OPERATION SLEEP OFF SLEEP OFF The sleep timer setting can also be canceled by pressing STANDBY on the remote control (or STANDBY/ON on the front panel) to set this unit to the standby mode. TRANSMIT SYSTEM POWER SLEEP y ■ Setting the sleep timer CODE SET Press SLEEP repeatedly until “SLEEP OFF” appears in the front panel display. After a few seconds, “SLEEP OFF” disappears, and the SLEEP indicator goes off. CD TUNED STEREO MEMORY MUTE VOLUME PTY RT CT EON 1E SLEEP8120minz dB ft mS dB 96/24 L C R LFE SL SB SR The SLEEP indicator lights up in the front panel display, and the display returns to the selected sound field program. SLEEP indicator t 96 24 VCR SILENT CINEMA MATRIX DISCRETE VIRTUAL SP AB q DIGITAL q EX q PL q PL q PL x PCM V-AUX DTV/CBL DVD NIGHT ZONE2 SLEEP MD/CD-R PTY HOLD AUTO HiFi DSP PS TUNER CD TUNED STEREO MEMORY MUTE VOLUME PTY RT CT EON 1E CONCERT2HALLz dB ft mS dB 96/24 L C R LFE SL SB SR English 43 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 44 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM ADVANCED OPERATIONS Manually adjusting speaker levels You can adjust the output level of each speaker while listening to a music source. This is also possible when playing sources through the MULTI CH INPUT jacks. Please note that this operation will override the level adjustments made in “BASIC SETUP” (page 23), “SP LEVEL” (page 48) and “Using the test tone” (page 44). AMP VCR TV VOL TV CH TV MUTE TV INPUT 1 VOLUME HALL JAZZ ROCK 1 2 3 4 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 9 0 10 You can use the test tone feature to manually balance your speaker levels. Please note that this operation will override the level adjustments made in “BASIC SETUP” (page 23), “SP LEVEL” (page 48) and “Manually adjusting speaker levels” (page 44). Use the test tone to set speaker levels so that the volume from each speaker is identical when heard from your listening position. Note You cannot activate the test tone if headphones are connected to the PHONES jack. Remove the headphones from the PHONES jack. MUTE STEREO Using the test tone AMP VCR ENTER EFFECT 2 LEVEL PRESET/CH TITLE MENU A/B/C/D/E SELECT 4 TEST RETURN TV VOL TV CH VOLUME TV MUTE TV INPUT STEREO HALL JAZZ 1 2 3 4 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 9 0 DISPLAY REC AUDIO 1 1 SET MENU MUTE 3 Press AMP. 10 ROCK ENTER EFFECT LEVEL PRESET/CH TITLE SET MENU MENU A/B/C/D/E SELECT 2 2,5 Press LEVEL repeatedly to select the speaker you want to adjust. FRONT L CENTER FRONT R SUR.R SUR.B SUR.L SWFR Front left speaker level Center speaker level Front right speaker level Surround right speaker level Surround back speaker level Surround left speaker level Subwoofer level y Press j / i to adjust the speaker output level. The control range is from +10 dB to –10 dB. 4 Press SELECT when you have completed your adjustment. y This operation can also be performed using the controls on the front panel. Press NEXT repeatedly to select the speaker you want to adjust, then press LEVEL –/+ to adjust the output level. 44 DISPLAY REC AUDIO 3,4 1 Press AMP. 2 Press TEST. The unit outputs a test tone. 3 Press u / d repeatedly to select the speaker you want to adjust. Once you press LEVEL, you can also select the speaker by pressing u / d. 3 TEST RETURN TEST TEST TEST TEST TEST TEST TEST LEFT CENTER RIGHT SUR.R SUR.B SUR.L SUBWOOFER Front left speaker Center speaker Front right speaker Right surround speaker Surround back speaker Left surround speaker Subwoofer 4 Press j / i to adjust speaker volumes. 5 Press TEST when you have completed your adjustment. The test tone stops. 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 45 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM SET MENU SET MENU You can use the following parameters in SET MENU to adjust a variety of system settings and customize the way this unit operates. Change the initial settings (indicated in bold under each parameter) to reflect the needs of your listening environment. ■ BASIC SETUP Use to quickly setup basic system parameters (see page 23). ■ MANUAL SETUP Use to adjust speaker and system settings. 1 SOUND MENU Use to manually adjust any speaker setting, alter the quality and tone of the sound output by the system or compensate for video signal processing delays when using LCD monitors or projectors. y Most of the parameters described in SOUND MENU are set automatically when you perform “BASIC SETUP” (see page 23). You can use SOUND MENU to make further adjustments. Item Features Page A)SPEAKER SET Selects the size of each speaker, the speakers for low-frequency signal output, and the cross over frequency. 47 B)SP LEVEL Adjusts the output level of each speaker. 48 C)SP DISTANCE Adjusts the delay time of each speaker. 48 D)CENTER GEQ Adjusts the tonal quality of the center speaker. 48 E)LFE LEVEL Adjusts the output level of the LFE channel for Dolby Digital or DTS signals. 48 F)D. RANGE Adjusts the dynamic range for Dolby Digital or DTS signals. 48 G)AUDIO SET Customizes the muting level and audio delay. 49 2 INPUT MENU Use to reassign digital input/outputs and select the input mode. Item Features Page Assigns jacks according to the component to be used. 49 B)INPUT MODE Selects the initial input mode of the source. 49 ADVANCED OPERATION A)I/O ASSIGN 3 OPTION MENU Use to adjust the optional system parameters. Item Features Page A)DISPLAY SET Adjusts the brightness of the display and converts video signals. 50 B)MEMORY GUARD Locks sound field program parameters and other SET MENU settings. 50 C)PARAM. INI Initializes the parameters of a group of sound field programs. 50 D)ZONE SET Specifies the location of the speakers connected to the SPEAKERS B terminals. 50 English 45 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 46 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM SET MENU Using SET MENU 6 Press SELECT to enter the displayed menu. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to navigate to and enter the items you want to adjust. To return to the previous menu level, press RETURN. 1 7 Press u / d to select the item you want to adjust, then press j / i to change the setting of the item. Repeat this operation to select and adjust each setting. To return to the previous menu level, press RETURN. 2,8 8 To exit, press SET MENU when finished. Use the remote control to access and adjust each parameter. AMP VCR TV VOL TV CH VOLUME TV MUTE TV INPUT STEREO HALL JAZZ 1 2 3 4 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 9 0 MUTE 10 ROCK ENTER EFFECT LEVEL PRESET/CH TITLE SET MENU MENU A/B/C/D/E SELECT TEST RETURN DISPLAY REC AUDIO 3-7 y You can change SET MENU parameters while the unit is reproducing sound. Note You cannot change some SET MENU parameters while the unit is in either cinema or music night listening mode. 1 Press AMP. 2 Press SET MENU. “BASIC SETUP” appears in the front panel display. 3 Press u / d to display MANUAL SETUP. MANUAL SETUP 4 Press SELECT to enter MANUAL SETUP. 1 SOUND MENU appears in the front panel display. 1 SOUND MENU 5 Press u / d to display the desired menu. 1 SOUND MENU 2 INPUT MENU 3 OPTION MENU 46 Memory back-up The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data from being lost even if this unit is in the standby mode. However, if the power cord is disconnected from the AC outlet, or the power supply is cut for more than one week, the stored data will be lost. If so, adjust the items again. 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 47 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM SET MENU 1 SOUND MENU Use to manually adjust any speaker setting or compensate for video signal processing delays when using LCD monitors or projectors. Most of the SOUND MENU parameters are set automatically when you perform “BASIC SETUP” (see page 23). ■ Speaker set A)SPEAKER SET Use to manually adjust any speaker setting. y If you are not satisfied with the bass sounds from your speakers, you can change these settings according to your preference. Center speaker CENTER Choices: LRG, SML, NONE • Select LRG if you have a large center speaker. The unit directs the entire range of the center channel signal to the center speaker. • Select SML if you have a small center speaker. The unit directs the low-frequency signals of the center channel to the speakers selected with “BASS OUT”. • Select NONE if you do not have a center speaker. The unit directs all of the center channel signal to the front left and right speakers. Front speakers FRONT Choices: LARGE, SMALL • Select LARGE if you have large front speakers. The unit directs the entire range of the front left and right channel signals to the front left and right speakers. • Select SMALL if you have small front speakers. The unit directs the low-frequency signals of the front channel to the speakers selected with “BASS OUT”. Bass out BASS OUT Low-frequency (bass) signals can be directed to the subwoofer and/or the front left and right speakers according to the characteristics of your system. This setting also determines the routing of the LFE (lowfrequency effect) signals found in Dolby Digital or DTS sources. Choices: SWFR (subwoofer), FRONT, BOTH • Select SWFR if you connect a subwoofer. LFE and low-frequency signals from other channels are directed to the subwoofer according to the speaker settings. • Select FRONT if you do not use a subwoofer. LFE and low-frequency signals from other channels are directed to the front speakers according to the speaker settings (even if you have previously set the front speakers to SMALL). • Select BOTH if you connect a subwoofer and you want to output low-frequency signals from front channels to both the front speakers and subwoofer. LFE and lowfrequency signals from other channels are also directed to the subwoofer according to the speaker settings. Use this function to reinforce low-frequency signals using the subwoofer when playing back sources such as CDs. Cross over CrossOver Use this feature to select a cross-over (cut-off) frequency for all low-frequency signals. All frequencies below the selected frequency will be sent to the subwoofer. Choices: 40Hz, 60Hz, 80Hz, 90Hz, 100Hz, 110Hz, 120Hz, 160Hz, 200Hz Subwoofer phase SWFR PHASE If bass sounds are lacking or unclear, use this feature to switch the phase of your subwoofer. Choices: NRM (normal), REV (reverse) • Select NRM if you do not want to reverse the phase of your subwoofer. • Select REV to reverse the phase of your subwoofer. ADVANCED OPERATION Surround left/right speakers SURR LR Choices: LRG, SML, NONE • Select LRG if you have large surround left and right speakers. The entire range of the surround channel signal is directed to the surround left and right speakers. • Select SML if you have small surround left and right speakers. The low-frequency signals of the surround channel are directed to the speakers selected with “BASS OUT”. • Select NONE if you do not have surround speakers. This will set the unit to the Virtual CINEMA DSP mode (see page 32) and automatically set the surround back speaker setting (SURR.B) to NONE. Surround back speaker SURR B Choices: LRG, SML, NONE • Select LRG if you have a large surround back speaker. • Select SML if you have a small surround back speaker. The low-frequency signals of the surround back channel are directed to the speakers selected with “BASS OUT”, and the rest of the frequency signals are directed to the surround back speaker. • Select NONE if you do not have a surround back speaker. The unit directs all of the surround back channel signal to the surround left and right speakers. English 47 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 48 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM SET MENU ■ Speaker level B)SP LEVEL ■ Center graphic equalizer D)CENTER GEQ Use these settings to manually balance the speaker levels between the front left or surround left speakers and each speaker selected in SPEAKER SET (page 47). Choices: –10.0 dB to +10.0 dB • FR adjusts the balance of the front left and front right speakers. • C adjusts the balance of the front left and center speakers. • SL adjusts the balance of the front left and surround left speakers. • SB adjusts the balance of the surround left and surround back speakers. • SR adjusts the balance of the surround left and surround right speakers. • SWFR adjusts the balance of the front left speaker and subwoofer. Use this feature to adjust the built-in 5-band graphic equalizer for the center channel so that the tonal quality of the center speaker matches that of the left and right main speakers. You can make adjustments listening to the currently selected source component or a test tone. You can adjust 5 frequency bands: 100Hz, 300Hz, 1kHz, 3kHz, 10kHz Choices: –6 to +6 dB • Select ON to output test tones from the front left and center speakers, and adjust the tonal quality of the center speaker. • Select OFF to stop the test tone and output the currently selected source component. y To calibrate, use the test tone feature (see page 44). ■ Speaker distance C)SP DISTANCE Use this feature to manually input the distance of each speaker and adjust the delay applied to respective channel. Ideally, each speaker should be the same distance from the main listening position. However, this is not possible in most home situations. Thus, a certain amount of delay must be applied to the sound from each speaker so that all sound will arrive at the listening position at the same time. Unit UNIT Choices: meters (m), feet (ft) Initial setting: U.S.A. and Canada models: feet (ft) Other models: meters (m) • Select meters to input speaker distances in meters. • Select feet to input speaker distances in feet. Speaker distances Choices: 0.3 to 24.00 m (1 to 80 ft) • FRONT L adjusts the distance of the front left speaker. Initial setting: 3.0 m (10.0 ft) • FRONT R adjusts the distance of the front right speaker. Initial setting: 3.0 m (10.0 ft) • CENTER adjusts the distance of the center speaker. Initial setting: 3.0 m (10.0 ft) • SURR L adjusts the distance of the surround left speaker. Initial setting: 3.0 m (10.0 ft) • SURR R adjusts the distance of the surround right speaker. Initial setting: 3.0 m (10.0 ft) • SURR B adjusts the distance of the surround back speaker. Initial setting: 2.10 m (7.0 ft) • SWFR adjusts the distance of the subwoofer. Initial setting: 3.0 m (10.0 ft) 48 ■ Low-frequency effect level E)LFE LEVEL Use to adjust the output level of the LFE (low-frequency effect) channel according to the capacity of your subwoofer or headphones. The LFE channel carries lowfrequency special effects which are only added to certain scenes. This setting is effective only when this unit decodes Dolby Digital or DTS signals. Choices: –20 to 0 dB Speaker SP LFE Select to adjust the speaker LFE level. Headphone HP LFE Select to adjust the headphone LFE level. Note Depending on the “LFE LEVEL” setting, some signals may not be output from the SUB WOOFER OUTPUT jack. ■ Dynamic range F)D. RANGE Use to select the amount of dynamic range compression to be applied to your speakers or headphones. This setting is effective only when the unit is decoding Dolby Digital and DTS signals. Choices: MAX (maximum), STD (standard), MIN (minimum) Speaker SP D.R Select to adjust the speaker compression. Headphone HP D.R Select to adjust the headphone compression. • Select MAX for feature films. • Select STD for general use. • Select MIN for listening to sources at low volume levels. 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 49 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM SET MENU ■ Audio set G)AUDIO SET Use to customize this units overall audio settings. Audio mute A.MUTE Use to adjust how much the mute function reduces the output volume. Choices: MUTE, –20 dB • Select MUTE to completely halt all output of sound. • Select –20 dB to reduce the current volume by 20 dB. Audio delay A.DELAY Use to delay the sound output and synchronize it with the video image. This may be necessary when using certain LCD monitors or projectors. Choices: 0 to 160 mS 2 INPUT MENU Use to reassign digital input/outputs and select the input mode. ■ Input/output assignment A)I/O ASSIGN You can assign jacks according to the component to be used if this unit’s initial settings do not correspond to your needs. Change the following parameters to reassign the respective jacks and effectively connect more components. Once the inputs have been reassigned, you can select the corresponding component by using INPUT on the front panel or the input selector buttons on the remote control. For COMPONENT VIDEO jacks A (C.V[A]) and B (C.V[B]) Choices: DVD, V-AUX, DTV/CBL, VCR For OPTICAL OUTPUT jack 1 (OUT(1)) Choices: MD/CD-R, CD, V-AUX, DTV/CBL, VCR, DVD For OPTICAL INPUT jacks 2 (IN(2)), 3 (IN(3)) and 4 (IN(4)) Choices: CD, V-AUX, DTV/CBL, VCR, DVD, MD/CD-R For COAXIAL INPUT jack 5 (IN(5)) Choices: CD, V-AUX, DTV/CBL, VCR, DVD, MD/CD-R Notes • You cannot select a specific item more than once for the same type of jack. • When you connect a component to both the COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks, priority is given to the input signals from the COAXIAL jack. ■ Input mode B)INPUT MODE ADVANCED OPERATION Use this feature to designate the input mode for sources connected to the DIGITAL INPUT jacks when you turn on this unit (see page 32 for details about the input mode). Choices: AUTO, LAST • Select AUTO to allow this unit to automatically detect the type of input signal and select the appropriate input mode. • Select LAST to set this unit to automatically select the last input mode used for that source. Note Even if LAST is selected, the last setting for the EX/ES button will not be recalled. English 49 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 50 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM SET MENU 3 OPTION MENU Use to adjust the optional system parameters. ■ Display set A)DISPLAY SET Dimmer DIMMER Use to adjust the brightness of the front panel display. Choices: –4 to 0 Video conversion V CONV. Use this feature to turn on/off conversion of composite (VIDEO) signals to S-Video signals. This allows you to output converted video signals from the S VIDEO jacks when no S-Video signals are input. Choices: ON, OFF • Select OFF not to convert any signals. • Select ON to convert composite signals to S-Video signals. ■ Parameter initialization C)PARAM. INI Use this feature to initialize the parameters for each sound field program within a sound field program group. When you initialize a sound field program group, all of the parameter values within that group revert to their initial settings. Press the corresponding numeric button for the sound field program that you want to initialize. An asterisk (*) next to a program number means that the parameter values have been changed from their initial settings. Notes • You cannot automatically revert to the previous parameter settings once you initialize a sound field program group. • You cannot separately initialize individual sound field programs. • You cannot initialize any program groups when “MEMORY GUARD” is set to ON. Note ■ Zone set D)ZONE SET Converted video signals are only output to the MONITOR OUT jacks. When recording you must make the same type of video connections (i.e., S-Video) between each component. Use to specify the location of speakers connected to the SPEAKERS B terminals. ■ Memory guard B)MEMORY GUARD Use this feature to prevent accidental changes to DSP program parameter values and other system settings. Choices: ON, OFF Select ON to protect: • DSP program parameters • All SET MENU items • All speaker levels When “MEMORY GUARD” is set to ON, you cannot use the test tone or select any other SET MENU items. Speaker B set SP B Use this feature to select the location of the front speakers connected to the SPEAKERS B terminals. Choices: FRONT, ZONE B • Select FRONT to turn on/off SPEAKERS A and B when the speakers connected to the SPEAKERS B terminals are set in the main room. • Select ZONE B if the speakers connected to the SPEAKERS B terminals are set in another room. If SPEAKERS A is turned OFF and SPEAKERS B is turned ON, all the speakers including the subwoofer in the main room are muted and the unit outputs sound from SPEAKERS B only. Notes • If you connect headphones to the PHONES jack on the unit when “SP B” is set to ZONE B, the sound is output from both headphones and SPEAKERS B. • If a DSP program is selected when “SP B” is set to ZONE B, the unit automatically enters the Virtual CINEMA DSP mode. 50 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 51 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES In addition to controlling this unit, the remote control can also operate other A/V components made by YAMAHA and other manufacturers. To control other components, you must set up remote control with the appropriate manufacturer codes. Control area ■ Controlling this unit ■ Controlling other components The shaded areas below can be used to control this unit when the AMP mode is selected. Press AMP to activate the AMP mode. The shaded areas below can be used to control other components. Each button has a different function depending on the selected components. Select the component you want to control by pressing an input selector button. CODE SET TRANSMIT SYSTEM POWER POWER TV AV CD MD/CD-R DVD DTV/CBL STANDBY POWER TUNER SLEEP MULTI CH IN V-AUX AMP VCR TV VOL TV CH TV MUTE TV INPUT STEREO HALL VOLUME The buttons in the dotted lines (SYSTEM POWER, STANDBY, SLEEP, MULTI CH IN, VOLUME +/– and MUTE) function in any mode. MUTE JAZZ ROCK 1 2 3 4 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 9 0 10 CODE SET / buttons and the input selector buttons switch the function of the component control area below. * Use the / buttons to control other components regardless of whether they are connected to this unit. Press AMP to control this unit. TITLE ENTER SET MENU MENU A/B/C/D/E SELECT TEST RETURN DISPLAY REC AUDIO DISC SKIP FREQ/RDS MODE PTY SEEK START EON SYSTEM STANDBY POWER MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN POWER TV AV CD DVD AMP VCR VOLUME TVTV VOL TVTV CHCH VOL TV VOL TVTV CHCH TV VOL TV VOL TVTV CHCH TV VOL TV VOL TVTV CHCH TV VOL TV VOL TVTV CHCH TV VOL TV VOL TV CH TVTV MUTE TVTV INPUT MUTE INPUT TV MUTE TV INPUT TV MUTE TV INPUT MUTE TV MUTE TV INPUT TV MUTE TV INPUT TV MUTE TV INPUT TV MUTE TV INPUT TV MUTE TV INPUT TV MUTE TV INPUT TV MUTE TV INPUT EFFECT PRESET/CH LEVEL TRANSMIT POWER Component control area You can control up to 9 different components by setting appropriate manufacturer codes (see page 52). FREQ/RDS MODE PTY SEEK START ADVANCED OPERATION STEREO HALL JAZZ ROCK STEREO HALL JAZZ ROCK STEREO HALL JAZZ ROCK HALL 3 JAZZ JAZZ 4 ROCK 1STEREO 22HALL ROCK 1STEREO 44ROCK HALL 33 JAZZ ROCK 1STEREO 22HALL JAZZ 1STEREO 33JAZZ HALL JAZZ 44 ROCK 1STEREO 22HALL STEREO HALL ROCK 1STEREO 3 4 ROCK HALL 3 JAZZ 11STEREOTV 22 33JAZZ 444ROCK MUSIC ENTERTAIN THTR MOVIE 1 2 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 11 2 33 44 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 2 ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 55MUSIC 6 7 8 ENTERTAIN THTR 66 77TVTV 88 MOVIE MUSIC ENTERTAIN THTR MOVIE 55MUSIC MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 6 7 8 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 55 MUSIC66ENTERTAIN 77 TV THTR 88 MOVIE ENTERTAIN 55 MUSIC EX/ES 66 77TV THTR 88 MOVIE q/DTS NIGHT 55 66 STRAIGHT 77 88 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT STRAIGHT ENTER 99 q/DTS 00 NIGHT 10 EX/ES q/DTS STRAIGHT ENTER q/DTS NIGHT10 EX/ES STRAIGHT ENTER 99 00NIGHT 10EX/ES q/DTS EX/ES STRAIGHT ENTER q/DTS NIGHT10 EX/ES STRAIGHT ENTER 99 0 NIGHT 10 q/DTS EX/ES STRAIGHT ENTER 10 EFFECT q/DTS00 NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT ENTER 99 EFFECT ENTER 00NIGHT 10 10 EFFECT ENTER 99 10 EFFECT ENTER 00 10 EFFECT PRESET/CH ENTER 9 10 EFFECT LEVEL SET MENU PRESET/CH EFFECT LEVEL SET MENU PRESET/CH EFFECT LEVEL SET MENU PRESET/CH EFFECT LEVEL SET MENU PRESET/CH EFFECT LEVEL SET MENU TITLE MENU PRESET/CH EFFECT LEVEL SET MENU TITLE MENU PRESET/CH LEVEL SET MENU TITLE MENU PRESET/CH LEVEL SET MENU TITLE MENU PRESET/CH LEVEL SET MENU TITLE MENU A/B/C/D/E PRESET/CH LEVEL SET MENU TITLE MENU A/B/C/D/E PRESET/CH LEVEL SET MENU TITLE MENU A/B/C/D/E TITLE MENU A/B/C/D/E TITLE MENU A/B/C/D/E TITLE MENU A/B/C/D/E SELECT TITLE MENU A/B/C/D/E SELECT A/B/C/D/E SELECT A/B/C/D/E SELECT A/B/C/D/E SELECT A/B/C/D/E SELECT TEST SELECT TEST SELECT TEST SELECT TEST SELECT RETURN DISPLAY TEST SELECT RETURN DISPLAY TEST RETURN DISPLAY TEST RETURN DISPLAY TEST RETURN DISPLAY TEST RETURN DISPLAY TEST RETURN DISPLAY TEST RETURN DISPLAY REC RETURN DISPLAY REC RETURN DISPLAY REC RETURN DISPLAY REC AUDIO REC AUDIO REC AUDIO REC AUDIO REC AUDIO REC DISC SKIP AUDIO REC DISC SKIP AUDIO REC DISC SKIP AUDIO DISC SKIP AUDIO DISC SKIP AUDIO DISC SKIP AUDIO DISC SKIP DISC SKIP DISC SKIP DISC SKIP EON MODE PTY SEEK START FREQ/RDS DISC SKIP EON English 51 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 52 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES Setting manufacturer codes 1 You can control other components by setting the appropriate manufacturer codes. Codes can be set up for each input area. For a complete list of available manufacturer codes, refer to “LIST OF MANUFACTURER CODES” at the end of this manual. Press an input selector button or / to select the component you want to set up. CD MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DVD DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN AMP VCR The following table shows the factory preset component (Library: component category) and the manufacturer code for each area. 2 Component category (Library) Manufacturer CD CD YAMAHA 0005 MD/CD-R MD YAMAHA 0024 Input area Code TUNER TUNER YAMAHA 0023*1 0003*2 DVD DVD YAMAHA 0098 DTV/CBL – – – V-AUX – – – VCR – – – – – – – – – Press CODE SET using a ballpoint pen or similar object. The TRANSMIT indicator on the remote control flashes twice. TRANSMIT CODE SET 3 Press the numeric buttons to enter the four digit manufacturer’s code for the component to be used. Refer to “LIST OF MANUFACTURER CODES” at the end of this manual. *1 U.K. and Europe models *2 Other models Note You may not be able to operate your YAMAHA component even if a YAMAHA manufacturer code is initially set as listed above. In this case, try to set other YAMAHA manufacturer code(s). STEREO HALL JAZZ 1 2 3 ROCK 4 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 9 0 10 ENTER EFFECT The TRANSMIT indicator on the remote control flashes twice. Notes • If the manufacturer of your component has more than one code, try each of them until you find the correct one. • If you wait for more than 30 seconds during step 3, the setup process is canceled. If this happens, start over from step 2. 52 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 53 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES Controlling other components Once you set the appropriate manufacturer codes, you can use this remote to control your other components. Note that some buttons may not correctly operate the selected component. Use the input selector buttons to select the component you want to operate. The remote control automatically switches to the appropriate control mode for that component. 1 2 CODE SET TRANSMIT STEREO HALL JAZZ 1 2 3 4 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 9 0 SYSTEM POWER POWER TV AV CD DVD MD/CD-R DTV/CBL POWER STANDBY TUNER 7 SLEEP MULTI CH IN V-AUX ROCK 10 ENTER B EFFECT 8 9 0 AMP VCR 3 4 TV VOL TV CH VOLUME PRESET/CH LEVEL SET MENU TITLE MENU A/B/C/D/E C SELECT TEST RETURN DISPLAY D REC 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 A A TV INPUT MUTE STEREO HALL JAZZ ROCK 1 2 3 4 DISC SKIP FREQ/RDS MODE PTY SEEK START EON DVD player/ DVD recorder VCR Digital TV/ Cable TV CD player MD/CD recorder Tuner AV POWER Power *1 Power *1 VCR power *3 Power *1 Power *1 Power *1 TV POWER TV power *2 TV power *2 TV power TV power *2 TV power *2 TV power *2 TV CH + TV channel up *2 TV channel up *2 TV channel up TV channel up *2 TV channel up *2 TV channel up *2 TV CH – TV channel down *2 TV channel down *2 TV channel down TV channel down *2 TV channel down *2 TV channel down *2 TV VOL + TV volume up *2 TV volume up *2 TV volume up TV volume up *2 TV volume up *2 TV volume up *2 TV VOL – TV volume down *2 TV volume down *2 TV volume down TV volume down *2 TV volume down *2 TV volume down *2 TV MUTE TV mute *2 TV mute *2 TV mute TV mute *2 TV mute *2 TV mute *2 TV INPUT TV input *2 TV input *2 TV input TV input *2 TV input *2 TV input *2 1-9, 0, +10 Numeric buttons Numeric buttons Numeric buttons Numeric buttons Numeric buttons Preset stations (1-8) TITLE Title PRESET/CH u Up VCR channel up Preset up PRESET/CH d Down VCR channel down Preset down PRESET/CH j Right PRESET/CH i Left RETURN Return REC/DISC SKIP Disc skip (player) Rec (recorder) Rec VCR rec *3 p Play Play VCR play *3 Play Play w Search backward Search backward VCR search backward *3 Search backward Search backward f Search forward Search forward VCR search forward *3 Search forward Search forward AUDIO Audio e Pause Pause VCR pause *3 Pause b Skip backward Skip backward Skip backward a Skip forward Skip forward Skip forward s Stop Stop VCR stop *3 Stop Stop ENTER Title/Index Enter Enter Index Index MENU Menu DISPLAY Display Display Display Display Rec (MD) Pause ADVANCED OPERATION B C D TV MUTE AUDIO A/B/C/D/E *1 This button functions only when the original remote control of the component has a POWER button. These buttons can operate your TV without switching the input if the manufacturer code is set in DTV/CBL or . When the manufacturer code for your TV is set up in both the DTV/CBL and areas, priority is given to the signal in the DTV/ CBL area. *3 These buttons can operate your VCR without switching the input to VCR if the manufacturer code is set in VCR. *2 English 53 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 54 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES Clearing setup manufacturer codes ■ Clearing a setup manufacturer code for component control 1 Press an input selector button or / to select the component control for which you want to clear the manufacturer code. CD MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DVD DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN VCR 2 AMP Press CODE SET using a ballpoint pen or similar object. The TRANSMIT indicator on the remote control flashes twice. TRANSMIT CODE SET 3 If you do not press any button within 30 seconds after step 2, the clearing process is canceled. If this happens, start over from step 1. 4 Enter the code number “0000”. The TRANSMIT indicator on the remote control flashes twice, and the manufacturer code for the selected component is cleared. y You can clear all setup manufacturer codes at once by entering the code number “9990”. 54 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 55 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM ZONE 2 (U.S.A., CANADA AND AUSTRALIA MODELS ONLY) ZONE 2 (U.S.A., CANADA AND AUSTRALIA MODELS ONLY) This unit allows you to configure a multi-room audio system. You can control this unit from the second room using the supplied remote control. Only analog signals are sent to the second room. Any source you want to listen to in the second room must be connected using the analog (AUDIO L/R) input jacks on this unit. Zone 2 connections You need the following additional equipment to use the multi-room functions of this unit: • An infrared signal receiver in the second room. • An infrared emitter in the main room. This emitter transmits the infrared signals from the remote control in the second room to the main room (to a CD player, for example). • An amplifier and speakers for the second room. y • Since there are many possible ways to connect and use this unit in a multi-room installation, we recommend that you consult with the nearest authorized YAMAHA dealer or service center for the Zone 2 connections which will best meet your requirements. • Some YAMAHA models are able to connect directly to the REMOTE CONTROL OUT jack of this unit. If you own these products, you may not need to use an infrared emitter. Up to 6 YAMAHA components can be connected as shown. IN OUT OUT REMOTE CONTROL OUT IN This unit ■ System configuration and connections example ZONE 2 OUTPUT Amplifier This unit ADVANCED OPERATION DVD player (or other component) Remote control DVD INPUT Infrared emitter Main room REMOTE CONTROL OUT Infrared signal receiver Second room ZONE 2 REMOTE IN Notes • When not using the main room, turn down the volume of this unit in the main room. Adjust the ZONE 2 volume using the amplifier in the second room. • To avoid unexpected noise, DO NOT USE the Zone 2 feature with CDs encoded in DTS. English 55 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 56 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM ZONE 2 (U.S.A., CANADA AND AUSTRALIA MODELS ONLY) Remote controlling Zone 2 3 The supplied remote control can be used to control Zone 2. You can even select the input source and control components located in the main room directly from the second room regardless of the listening condition in the main room. Press an input selector button to select the input source you want to listen to in the second room. ■ To enable Zone 2 mode on the remote control 1 Press CD MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DVD DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN AMP VCR . CD MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DVD DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN VCR 4 You can control Zone 2 using the input selector buttons, STANDBY, SYSTEM POWER and MUTE. AMP CODE SET TRANSMIT SYSTEM 2 Press CODE SET using a ballpoint pen or similar object. The TRANSMIT indicator on the remote control flashes twice. STANDBY POWER MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN POWER POWER TV AV CD DVD AMP VCR TV VOL TV CH TV MUTE TV INPUT VOLUME MUTE TRANSMIT CODE SET y 3 Enter the code number “2999”. Immediately after you have configured the remote control for Zone 2, the remote will enter main mode. When the remote is in main mode, you can turn the main unit on, or set it in standby mode independently of Zone 2 by pressing SYSTEM POWER or STANDBY. ■ To control Zone 2 1 Press to set the remote control to Zone 2. The TRANSMIT indicator on the remote control lights up while the remote control is in Zone 2 mode. 2 Press SYSTEM POWER to turn Zone 2 power on. 56 Zone 2 volume cannot be adjusted with the remote control. Use the control on the amplifier in the second room. Note The remote control returns to main mode 10 seconds after you press , or if you press any button other than SYSTEM POWER, STANDBY, MUTE or the input selector buttons. If the TRANSMIT indicator is turned off, press to set the remote control to Zone 2 mode before turning Zone 2 power on or off, changing the input source, or muting the sound. 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 57 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM ZONE 2 (U.S.A., CANADA AND AUSTRALIA MODELS ONLY) ■ When you have finished using the unit To set both the main unit and Zone 2 to standby mode While holding down AMP, press STANDBY. y • You can turn on both the main unit and Zone 2 simultaneously by holding down AMP and pressing SYSTEM POWER. • SYSTEM POWER and STANDBY work differently depending on the selected mode. TRANSMIT indicator SYSTEM POWER/ STANDBY Main mode Off Turns the main unit on/standby Zone 2 mode On Turns Zone 2 to on/ standby ■ Special considerations for DTS software The DTS signal is a digital bitstream. If you attempt to send the DTS signal to the second room you will only hear digital noise (that may damage your speakers). Thus, the following considerations and adjustments need to be made when playing DTS-encoded discs. For DVDs encoded in DTS Only 2 channel analog audio signals may be sent to the second room. Use the disc menu to set the DVD player’s mixed 2channel left and right audio outputs to the PCM or Dolby Digital soundtrack. For CDs encoded in DTS To avoid unexpected noise, DO NOT USE the Zone 2 feature with CDs encoded in DTS. ADVANCED OPERATION English 57 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 58 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM EDITING SOUND FIELD PARAMETERS EDITING SOUND FIELD PARAMETERS What is a sound field What really creates the rich, full tones of a live instrument are the multiple reflections from the walls of the room. In addition to making the sound “live”, these reflections enable us to tell where the player is situated, and the size and shape of the room in which we are sitting. Changing parameter settings You can enjoy good quality sound with the factory preset parameters. Although you do not have to change the initial settings, you can change some of the parameters to better suit the input source or your listening room. MUTE CODE SET ■ Elements of a sound field TRANSMIT SYSTEM In any environment, in addition to the direct sound coming straight to our ears from the player’s instrument, there are two distinct types of sound reflections that combine to make up the sound field: 1 STANDBY POWER MD/CD-R TUNER SLEEP DTV/CBL V-AUX MULTI CH IN POWER POWER TV AV CD DVD STEREO HALL JAZZ 1 2 3 4 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 9 0 10 ROCK 2 ENTER EFFECT AMP VCR LEVEL PRESET/CH SET MENU TITLE MENU A/B/C/D/E SELECT TEST Early reflections Reflected sounds reach our ears extremely rapidly (50 ms – 100 ms after the direct sound), after reflecting from one surface only — for example, from the ceiling or a wall. Early reflections actually add clarity to the direct sound. Reverberations These are caused by reflections from more than one surface — walls, ceiling, the back of the room — so numerous that they merge together to form a continuous sonic “afterglow”. They are non-directional, and lessen the clarity of the direct sound. TV CH TV INPUT VOLUME RETURN DISPLAY REC AUDIO 1 Press AMP. 2 Select the sound field program you want to adjust. AMP STEREO HALL JAZZ ROCK 1 2 3 4 MUSIC ENTERTAIN TV THTR MOVIE 5 6 7 8 q/DTS NIGHT EX/ES STRAIGHT 9 0 10 ENTER EFFECT 3 Press u / d to select the parameters. PRESET/CH SELECT 4 Press j / i to change the parameter value. PRESET/CH SELECT 58 3,4 DISC SKIP Direct sound, early reflections and subsequent reverberation taken together help us to determine the subjective size and shape of the room, and it is this information that the digital sound field processor reproduces in order to create sound fields. If you could create the appropriate early reflections and subsequent reverberations in your listening room, you would be able to create your own listening environment. The acoustics in your room could be changed to those of a concert hall, a dance floor, or virtually any size room at all. This ability to create sound fields at will is exactly what YAMAHA has done with the digital sound field processor. TV VOL TV MUTE 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 59 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM EDITING SOUND FIELD PARAMETERS 5 Repeat steps 2 through 4 as necessary to change other program parameters. Note You cannot change parameter values when “MEMORY GUARD” is set to ON. If you want to change the parameter values, set “MEMORY GUARD” to OFF (see page 50). Memory back-up The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data from being lost even if this unit is set in the standby mode, the power cord is disconnected from the AC outlet, or the power supply is temporarily cut due to power failure. However, if the power is cut for more than one week, the parameter values will return to the factory settings. If this happens, edit the parameter value again. ■ Resetting parameters to the factory presets To reset a certain parameter Select the parameter you want to reset, then press j / i repeatedly to select the factory preset (the display pauses momentarily at the factory preset before proceeding to the next value). To reset all parameters Use PARAM. INI (see page 50). ADDITIONAL INFORMATION English 59 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 60 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM SOUND FIELD PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS SOUND FIELD PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS You can adjust the values of certain digital sound field parameters so the sound fields are recreated accurately in your listening room. Not all of the following parameters are found in every program. ■ DSP LEVEL Function: Description: Control range: This parameter adjusts the level of all the DSP effect sounds within a narrow range. Depending on the acoustics of your listening room, you may want to increase or decrease the DSP effect level relative to the level of the direct sound. –6 dB – +3 dB ■ DELAY (Delay) Function: Description: Control range: This parameter changes the apparent distance from the source sound by adjusting the delay between the direct sound and the first reflection heard by the listener. The smaller the value, the closer the sound source seems to the listener. The larger the value, the farther it seems. For a small room, set to a small value. For a large room, set to a large value. 1 – 99 msec Source Sound Time Time Time DELAY Level Level Level Early Reflections DELAY DELAY Sound Source Reflection Face Small value = 1 ms Large value = 99 ms For 6ch Stereo Function: These parameter adjusts the volume level for each channel in 6-channel stereo mode. Control Range: 0 – 100% ■ CT LEVEL (Center level) ■ SL LEVEL (Surround left level) ■ SR LEVEL (Surround right level) ■ SB LEVEL (Surround back level) 60 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 61 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM SOUND FIELD PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS For PRO LOGIC IIx Music and PRO LOGIC II Music ■ PANORAMA Function: Choices: Extends the front stereo image to include the surround speakers for wraparound effect. OFF/ON, initial setting is OFF. ■ DIMENSION Function: Control range: Gradually adjusts the sound field either towards the front or towards the rear. –3 (towards the rear) to +3 (towards the front), initial setting is STD (standard). ■ CT WIDTH (Center width) Function: Control range: Adjusts the center image from all three front speakers to varying degrees. A larger value adjusts the center image towards the front left and right speakers. 0 (center channel sound is output only from center speaker) to 7 (center channel sound is output only from front left and right speakers), initial setting is 3. For PRO LOGIC IIx Movie, Music and Game ■ PLII/PLIIx (Pro Logic II/Pro Logic IIx) Function: Choices: Switches the type of Pro Logic decoding to be used. PLII decoding creates 5.1-channel sound from 2-channel sources. PLIIx decoding creates 6.1-channel sound from 2-channel sources. PLII, PLIIx For DTS Neo:6 Music ■ C. IMAGE (Center image) Function: Control range: This parameter adjusts the center image from all three front speakers to varying degrees. 0 – 0.5 ADDITIONAL INFORMATION English 61 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 62 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM TROUBLESHOOTING TROUBLESHOOTING Refer to the chart below when this unit does not function properly. If the problem you are experiencing is not listed below or if the instruction below does not help, set this unit to the standby mode, disconnect the power cord, and contact the nearest authorized YAMAHA dealer or service center. ■ General Problem This unit fails to turn on when STANDBY/ ON (or SYSTEM POWER) is pressed, or enters in the standby mode soon after the power has been turned on. No sound No picture 62 Cause Remedy Refer to page The power cord is not connected or the plug is not completely inserted. Connect the power cord firmly. — The impedance setting is incorrect. Set the impedance to match your speakers. 21 The protection circuitry has been activated. Make sure all speaker wire connections on this unit and on all speakers are secure and that the wire for each connection does not touch anything other than its respective connection. This unit has been exposed to a strong external electric shock (such as lightning and strong static electricity). Set this unit in the standby mode, disconnect the power cord, plug it back in after 30 seconds, then use it normally. — Incorrect input or output cable connections. Connect the cables properly. If the problem persists, the cables may be defective. 15-18 The input mode is set to DTS or ANALOG. Select AUTO. 32 No appropriate input source has been selected. Select an appropriate input source with INPUT, MULTI CH INPUT or the input selector buttons. 26 Speaker connections are not secure. Secure the connections. 12 The front speakers to be used have not been selected properly. Select the front speakers with SPEAKERS A and/or B. 26 The volume is turned down. Turn up the volume. — The sound is muted. Press MUTE or any operation buttons of this unit to cancel a mute and adjust the volume. 27 The input mode is set to ANALOG while playing a source encoded with a DTS signal. Set the input mode to AUTO or DTS. 32 The signals this unit cannot reproduce are being received from a source component e.g.: a CD-ROM. Play a source whose signals this unit can reproduce. — The output and input for the picture are connected to different types of video jacks. Turn on the video conversion function. 50 12-13 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 63 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM TROUBLESHOOTING Problem The sound suddenly goes off. Cause Remedy Refer to page Check that the impedance selector setting is correct. 21 Check that the speaker wires are not touching each other and then turn this unit back on. — The sleep timer has turned the unit off. Turn on the power, and play the source again. — The sound is muted. Press MUTE to cancel a mute. 27 Only the speaker on one side can be heard. Incorrect cable connections. Connect the cables properly. If the problem persists, the cables may be defective. 12 Incorrect balance settings in SET MENU. Adjust the SP LEVEL settings. 48 Only the center speaker outputs substantial sound. When playing a monaural source with a CINEMA DSP program, the source signal is directed to the center channel, and the front and surround speakers output effect sounds. No sound from the effect speakers. The sound field programs are turned off. Press STRAIGHT (EFFECT) to turn them on. 32 You are using a source or program combination that does not output sound from all channels. Try another sound field program. The output level of the center speaker is set to minimum. Raise the level of the center speaker. 48 “CENTER” in SET MENU is set to NONE. Select the appropriate setting for the center speaker. 47 One of the Hi-Fi DSP programs (except for 6ch Stereo) has been selected. Try another sound field program. The output level of the surround speakers is set to minimum. Raise the output level of the surround speakers. 48 “SURR LR” in SET MENU is set to NONE. Select the appropriate setting for the surround left and right speakers. 47 A monaural source is being played with STRAIGHT. Press STRAIGHT (EFFECT) to turn on the sound fields. — “SURR LR” in SET MENU is set to NONE. If the surround left and right speakers are set to NONE, the surround back speaker setting is automatically set to NONE. Select the appropriate setting for the surround speakers. 47 “SURR B” in SET MENU is set to NONE. Select LRG or SML. 47 “BASS OUT” in SET MENU is set to FRONT when a Dolby Digital or DTS signal is being played. Select SWFR or BOTH. 47 “BASS OUT” in SET MENU is set to SWFR or FRONT when a 2-channel source is being played. Select BOTH. 47 No sound from the center speaker. No sound from the surround speakers. No sound from the surround back speaker. No sound from the subwoofer. The protection circuitry has been activated because of a short circuit, etc. 28, 40 28, 40 ADDITIONAL INFORMATION The source does not contain low bass signals. English 63 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 64 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM TROUBLESHOOTING Problem Cause Remedy Refer to page Dolby Digital or DTS sources cannot be played. (Dolby Digital or DTS indicator in the front panel display does not light up.) The connected component is not set to output Dolby Digital or DTS digital signals. Make an appropriate setting following the operations instructions for your component. — The input mode is set to ANALOG. Set the input mode to AUTO or DTS. 32 A “humming” sound can be heard. Incorrect cable connections. Firmly connect the audio plugs. If the problem persists, the cables may be defective. — The volume level cannot be increased, or the sound is distorted. The component connected to the OUT (REC) jacks of this unit is turned off. Turn on the power to the component. — The sound effect cannot be recorded. It is not possible to record the sound effect with a recording component. A source cannot be recorded by a digital recording component connected to this DIGITAL OUTPUT jack. The source component is not connected to this unit’s DIGITAL INPUT jacks. A source cannot be recorded by an analog component connected to the AUDIO OUT jacks. Connect the source component to the DIGITAL INPUT jacks. 14-18, 39 The source component is not connected to this unit’s analog AUDIO IN jacks. Connect the source component to the analog AUDIO IN jacks. 14-18, 39 The sound field parameters and some other settings on this unit cannot be changed. “MEMORY GUARD” in SET MENU is set to ON. Select OFF. 50 This unit does not operate properly. The internal microcomputer has been frozen by an external electric shock (such as lightning or excessive static electricity) or by a power supply with low voltage. Disconnect the AC power cord from the outlet and then plug it in again after about 30 seconds. — “CHECK SP WIRES” appears in the front panel display. Speaker cables are short circuited. Make sure all speaker cables are connected correctly. 12 There is noise interference from digital or highfrequency equipment, or this unit. This unit is too close to the digital or highfrequency equipment. Move this unit further away from such equipment. — The picture is disturbed. The video source uses scrambled or encoded signals to prevent dubbing. This unit suddenly turns into the standby mode. The internal temperature becomes too high and the overheat protection circuitry has been activated. Wait about 1 hour for this unit to cool down and then turn it back on. — 64 Some components cannot record the Dolby Digital or DTS sources. 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 65 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM TROUBLESHOOTING ■ Tuner Problem Cause FM stereo reception is noisy. FM AM Remedy Refer to page The characteristics of FM stereo broadcasts may cause this problem when the transmitter is too far away or the antenna input is poor. Check the antenna connections. Try using a high-quality directional FM antenna. 19 Use the manual tuning method. 35 There is distortion, and clear reception cannot be obtained even with a good FM antenna. There is multipath interference. Adjust the antenna position to eliminate multipath interference. — The desired station cannot be tuned in with the automatic tuning method. The signal is too weak. Use a high-quality directional FM antenna. 19 Use the manual tuning method. 35 Previously preset stations can no longer be tuned in. This unit has been disconnected for a long period. Preset the stations again. 35 The desired station cannot be tuned in with the automatic tuning method. The signal is weak or the antenna connections are loose. Tighten the AM loop antenna connections and orient it for best reception. — Use the manual tuning method. 35 There are continuous crackling and hissing noises. Noises result from lightning, fluorescent lamps, motors, thermostats and other electrical equipment. Use an outdoor antenna and a ground wire. This will help somewhat, but it is difficult to eliminate all noise. — There are buzzing and whining noises. A TV set is being used nearby. Move this unit away from the TV. — ■ Remote control Problem The remote control does not work nor function properly. Cause Remedy Refer to page The remote control will function within a maximum range of 6 m (20 ft) and no more than 30 degrees offaxis from the front panel. 7 Direct sunlight or lighting (from an inverter type of fluorescent lamp, etc.) is striking the remote control sensor of this unit. Reposition this unit. — The batteries are weak. Replace all batteries. 3 The manufacturer code was not correctly set. Set the manufacturer code correctly using the “LIST OF MANUFACTURER CODES” at the end of this manual. 52 Try to set another code for the same manufacturer using the “LIST OF MANUFACTURER CODES” at the end of this manual. 52 ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Wrong distance or angle. Even if the manufacturer code is correctly set, there are some models that do not respond to the remote control. English 65 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 66 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM RESETTING THE FACTORY PRESETS RESETTING THE FACTORY PRESETS If you want to reset all of your unit’s parameters for any reason, do the following. This procedure completely resets ALL parameters, including the SET MENU, level, assign and tuner presets. Be sure this unit is in standby mode. (U.S.A. model) VOLUME PRESET/TUNING FM/AM EDIT A/B/C/D/E l PRESET/TUNING h NEXT LEVEL PROGRAM MEMORY TUNING MODE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO INPUT PHONES SPEAKERS A B STRAIGHT TONE CONTROL INPUT MODE MULTI CH INPUT STANDBY /ON VIDEO AUX EFFECT SILENT CINEMA VIDEO STANDBY/ON 1 L AUDIO R STRAIGHT (EFFECT) Hold down STRAIGHT (EFFECT) on the front panel and press STANDBY/ON. “FACTORY PRESET” appears in the front panel display. y To cancel the initialization procedure without making any changes, press STANDBY/ON. 2 Press STRAIGHT (EFFECT) to select the desired setting. Reset Cancel 3 66 To reset the unit to its factory presets. To cancel without making any changes. Press STANDBY/ON to confirm your selection. If you selected “Reset”, the unit is reset to its factory presets and switches to standby mode. If you selected “Cancel”, the unit switches to standby mode and nothing is reset. 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 67 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM GLOSSARY GLOSSARY Audio formats ■ Dolby Digital Dolby Digital is a digital surround sound system that gives you completely independent multi-channel audio. With 3 front channels (left, center, and right), and 2 surround stereo channels, Dolby Digital provides 5 full-range audio channels. With an additional channel especially for bass effects, called LFE (low frequency effect), the system has a total of 5.1-channels (LFE is counted as 0.1 channel). By using 2-channel stereo for the surround speakers, more accurate moving sound effects and surround sound environment are possible than with Dolby Surround. The wide dynamic range (from maximum to minimum volume) reproduced by the 5 full-range channels and the precise sound orientation generated using digital sound processing provide listeners with previously unheard of excitement and realism. With this unit, any sound environment from monaural up to a 5.1-channel configuration can be freely selected for your enjoyment. ■ Dolby Digital Surround EX Dolby Digital EX creates 6 full-bandwidth output channels from 5.1-channel sources. This is done using a matrix decoder that derives 3 surround channels from the 2 in the original recording. For the best results, Dolby Digital EX should be used with movie sound tracks recorded with Dolby Digital Surround EX. With this additional channel, you can experience more dynamic and realistic moving sound especially with scenes with “flyover” and “fly-around” effects. ■ Dolby Pro Logic II ■ Dolby Pro Logic IIx Dolby Pro Logic IIx is a new technology enabling discrete multi-channel playback from 2-channel or multi-channel sources. There is a Music mode for music, a Movie mode for movies (for 2-channel sources only) and a Game mode for games. Dolby Surround uses a 4 channel analog recording system to reproduce realistic and dynamic sound effects: 2 front left and right channels (stereo), a center channel for dialog (monaural), and a surround channel for special sound effects (monaural). The surround channel reproduces sound within a narrow frequency range. Dolby Surround is widely used with nearly all video tapes and laser discs, and in many TV and cable broadcasts as well. The Dolby Pro Logic decoder built into this unit employs a digital signal processing system that automatically stabilizes the volume on each channel to enhance moving sound effects and directionality. ■ DTS 96/24 DTS 96/24 offers an unprecedented level of audio quality for multi-channel sound on DVD-Video, and is fully backward-compatible with all DTS decoders. “96” refers to a 96 kHz sampling rate (compared to the typical 48 kHz sampling rate). “24” refers to 24-bit word length. DTS 96/ 24 offers sound quality transparent to the original 96/24 master, and 96/24 5.1-channel sound with full-quality fullmotion video for music programs and motion picture soundtracks on DVD-video. ■ DTS (Digital Theater Systems) Digital Surround DTS digital surround was developed to replace the analog soundtracks of movies with a 6-channel digital sound track, and is now rapidly gaining popularity in movie theaters around the world. Digital Theater Systems Inc. has developed a home theater system so that you can enjoy the depth of sound and natural spatial representation of DTS digital surround in your home. This system produces practically distortion-free 6-channel sound (technically, a left, right and center channels, 2 surround channels, plus an LFE 0.1 channel as a subwoofer, for a total of 5.1channels). The unit incorporates a DTS-ES decoder that enables 6.1- channel reproduction by adding the surround back channel to existing 5.1-channel format. ■ Neo:6 Neo:6 decodes the conventional 2-channel sources for 6 channel playback by the specific decoder. It enables playback with the full-range channels with higher separation just like digital discrete signal playback. Two modes are available; “Music mode” for playing music sources and “Cinema mode” for movies. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Dolby Pro Logic II is an improved technique used to decode vast numbers of existing Dolby Surround software. This new technology enables a discrete 5-channel playback with 2 front left and right channels, 1 center channel, and 2 surround left and right channels (instead of only 1 surround channel for conventional Pro Logic technology). Music and Game modes are also available for 2-channel sources in addition to the Movie mode. ■ Dolby Surround English 67 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 68 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM GLOSSARY Sound field programs Audio information ■ CINEMA DSP ■ ITU-R Since the Dolby Surround and DTS systems were originally designed for use in movie theaters, their effect is best felt in a theater having many speakers and designed for acoustic effects. Since home conditions, such as room size, wall material, number of speakers, and so on, can differ so widely, it’s inevitable that there are differences in the sound heard as well. Based on a wealth of actually measured data, YAMAHA CINEMA DSP uses YAMAHA original sound field technology to combine Dolby Pro Logic, Dolby Digital and DTS systems to provide the visual and audio experience of movie theater in the listening room of your own home. ITU-R is the radio communication sector of the ITU (International Telecommunication Union). ITU-R recommends a standard speaker placement which is used in many critical listening rooms, especially for mastering purposes. ■ SILENT CINEMA YAMAHA has developed a natural, realistic sound effect DSP algorithm for headphones. Parameters for headphones have been set for each sound field so that accurate representations of all the sound field programs can be enjoyed on headphones. ■ Virtual CINEMA DSP YAMAHA has developed a Virtual CINEMA DSP algorithm that allows you to enjoy DSP sound field surround effects even without any surround speakers by using virtual surround speakers. It is even possible to enjoy Virtual CINEMA DSP using a minimal two-speaker system that does not include a center speaker. 68 ■ LFE 0.1 channel This channel is for the reproduction of low bass signals. The frequency range for this channel is 20 Hz to 120 Hz. This channel is counted as 0.1 because it only enforces a low frequency range compared to the full-range reproduced by the other 5/6 channels in Dolby Digital or DTS 5.1/6.1-channel systems. ■ PCM (Linear PCM) Linear PCM is a signal format under which an analog audio signal is digitized, recorded and transmitted without using any compression. This is used as a method of recording CDs and DVD audio. The PCM system uses a technique for sampling the size of the analog signal per very small unit of time. Standing for “pulse code modulation”, the analog signal is encoded as pulses and then modulated for recording. ■ Sampling frequency and number of quantized bits When digitizing an analog audio signal, the number of times the signal is sampled per second is called the sampling frequency, while the degree of fineness when converting the sound level into a numeric value is called the number of quantized bits. The range of rates that can be played back is determined based on the sampling rate, while the dynamic range representing the sound level difference is determined by the number of quantized bits. In principle, the higher the sampling frequency, the wider the range of frequencies that can be played back, and the higher the number of quantized bits, the more finely the sound level can be reproduced. 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 69 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM GLOSSARY Video signal information ■ Component video signal With the component video signal system, the video signal is separated into the Y signal for the luminance and the PB and PR signals for the chrominance. Color can be reproduced more faithfully with this system because each of these signals is independent. The component signal is also called the “color difference signal” because the luminance signal is subtracted from the color signal. A monitor with component input jacks is required in order to use the component signal for output. ■ Composite video signal With the composite video signal system, the video signal is composed of three basic elements of a video picture; color, brightness and synchronization data. A composite video jack on a video component transmits these three elements combined. ■ S-Video signal With the S-Video signal system, the video signal normally transmitted using a pin cable is separated and transmitted as the Y signal for the luminance and the C signal for the chrominance through the S-Video cable. Using the S VIDEO jack eliminates video signal transmission loss and allows recording and playback of even more beautiful images. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION English 69 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 70 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM SPECIFICATIONS SPECIFICATIONS AUDIO SECTION VIDEO SECTION • Minimum RMS Output Power for Front, Center, Surround, Surround back 20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.06% THD, 8 Ω....................................... 90 W • Video Signal Type .......................................................... PAL/NTSC • Maximum Power (EIAJ) [China, Korea and General models] 1 kHz, 10% THD, 8 Ω ......................................................... 130 W • Dynamic Power (IHF) 8/6/4/2 Ω ....................................................... 120/155/190/235 W • DIN Standard Output Power [U.K., Europe and Asia models] 1 kHz, 0.7% THD, 4 Ω ........................................................ 135 W • IEC Output Power [U.K., Europe and Asia models] 1 kHz, 0.06% THD, 8 Ω ...................................................... 100 W • Signal to Noise Ratio .............................................................. 50 dB • Frequency Response (MONITOR OUT) Composite, S-Video ................................. 5 Hz to 10 MHz, –3 dB Component .............................................. 5 Hz to 60 MHz, –3 dB FM SECTION • Tuning Range [U.S.A. and Canada models] .......................... 87.5 to 107.9 MHz [Asia and General model] ......... 87.5/87.50 to 108.0/108.00 MHz [Other models] ............................................ 87.50 to 108.00 MHz • Usable Sensitivity (IHF) ....................................... 1.0 µV (11.2 dBf) • Damping Factor (IHF) 20 Hz to 20 kHz, 8 Ω ...................................................100 or more • Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF) Mono/Stereo ............................................................. 76 dB/70 dB • Frequency Response CD terminal to Front L/R ...................... 10 Hz to 100 kHz, –3 dB • Harmonic Distortion (1 kHz) Mono/Stereo ................................................................ 0.2%/0.3% • Total Harmonic Distortion CD, etc. to Front L/R (20 Hz to 20 kHz, 40 W, 8 Ω) ........... 0.06% • Stereo Separation (1 kHz) ....................................................... 42 dB • Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF-A Network) CD (250 mV) to Front L/R, Effect Off ................................100 dB • Residual Noise (IHF-A Network) Front L/R ................................................................ 150 µV or less • Channel Separation (1 kHz/10 kHz) CD (5.1 kΩ terminated) to Front L/R ....................... 60 dB/45 dB • Tone Control (Front L/R) BASS Boost/Cut ...................................................... ±10 dB/60 Hz TREBLE Boost/Cut .............................................. ±10 dB/20 kHz • Phones Output .......................................................... 150 mV/100 Ω • Input Sensitivity/Input Impedance CD, etc. ................................................................. 200 mV/47 kΩ MULTI CH INPUT ............................................... 200 mV/47 kΩ • Output Level/Output Impedance REC OUT.............................................................. 200 mV/1.2 kΩ SUB WOOFER ........................................................... 4 V/1.2 kΩ ZONE 2 OUTPUT [U.S.A., Canada and Australia models] ............. 200 mV/1.2 kΩ • Frequency Response ......................... 20 Hz to 15 kHz, +0.5, –2 dB AM SECTION • Tuning Range [U.S.A. and Canada models] .............................. 530 to 1710 kHz [Asia and General models] ................. 530/531 to 1710/1611 kHz [Other models] .................................................... 531 to 1611 kHz • Usable Sensitivity ............................................................. 300 µV/m GENERAL • Power Supply [U.S.A. and Canada models] ............................. AC 120 V, 60 Hz [Australia model] ............................................... AC 240 V, 50 Hz [China model] .................................................... AC 220 V, 50 Hz [Korea model] .................................................... AC 220 V, 60 Hz [U.K. and Europe models] ................................. AC 230 V, 50 Hz [General model] ................ AC 110/120/220/230-240 V, 50/60 Hz [Asia model] ....................................AC 220/230-240 V, 50/60 Hz • Power Consumption [U.S.A. and Canada models] ................................. 350 W/440 VA [Other models] .................................................................... 360 W • Standby Power Consumption ................................................. 0.1 W • AC Outlets [U.K. and Australia models] ............... 1 (Total 100 W maximum) [Asia and General models] ................... 2 (Total 50 W maximum) [Other models] ..................................... 2 (Total 100 W maximum) • Dimension (W x H x D) ................................... 435 x 171 x 420 mm (17-1/8” x 6-3/4” x 16-1/2”) • Weight ................................................................. 11 kg (24 lbs 4 oz) 70 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page i Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM LIST OF MANUFACTURER CODES TV A TANDY 0941 ABEX 1151 ADMIRA 1141 ADVENTURA 1131 AIKO 1121 AIWA 1481 AKAI 0331, 1101, 1111 ALBA 0431 ALLERON 1091 AMBASSADOR 1081 AMSTRAD 0481, 1081 ANAM 0251, 1041, 1051, 1061, 1071 ANAM NATIONAL 1041 AOC 0361, 1021, 1031, 1111, 1161 ARCHER 1161 AUDIOSONIC 1001 AUDIOVOX 1051, 1161 BAUER 0441 BAUR 1001 BEIJING 1511, 1551, 1561 BELCOR 1031 BELL & HOWELL 0981, 0991 BEON 1001 BRADFORD 1051 BROCKWOOD 1031 BROKSONIC 1161 BUSH 1001 CANDLE 0351, 0361, 0961, 0971, 1111, 1131 CAPEHART 1021 CARVER 0101 CATHAY 1001 CELEBRITY 0951 CENTURION 0411 CHANGHONG 1541, 1551, 1561, 1621 CITIZEN 0351, 0361, 0921, 0931, 0941, 0961, 0971, 1111, 1121, 1131 CLAIRTONE 1011 CLARIVOX 1001 CONCERTO 0351, 0971 CONROWA 1751 CONTEC 0901, 0911, 1011, 1051 CORANDO 0941 CRAIG 0251, 1051 CROWN 0941, 1051 CURTIS MATHES 0161, 0361, 0931, 0941, 0981, 1111 CXC 1051 DAEWOO 0291, 0301, 0331, 0721, 0941, 1001, 1031, 1121, 1191, 1531, 1581, 1591, 1601 DANSAI 1001 DAYTRON 0941, 1031 DECCA 0271, 1001 DIXI 0331, 1001, 1071 DUMONT 0891, 1031 DYNATECH 0881 ELECTROBAND 0951, 1011 ELECTROHOME 0941 ELECTRON 0941 ELIN 1001 ELTA 0331 EMERSON 0001, 0021, 0061, 0071, 0081, 0091, 0111, 0811, 0821, 0831, 0841, 0851, 0861, 0871, 0901, 0921, 0941, 0981, 1011, 1031, 1051, 1081, 1091 ENVISION 0361, 1111 ERRES 1001 ETRON 0331 FERGUSON 1001 FINLUX 1001 FISHER 0171, 0801, 0981 FORMENTI 0441 FORMONTI 1001 FORTRESS 1141 FUJITSU 1091 FUNAI 1051, 1091, 1501, 1521 FUTURETECH 1051 GE 0131, 0161, 0201, 0751, 0761, 0771, 0781, 0791, 0811, 0861, 1041 GEC 0271, 1001 GEMINI 0391 GENEXXA 0431 GIBRALTER 0891, 1031, 1111 GOODMANS/TASHIKO 0271, 0661, 1001 GRANADA 1001 GRUNDIG 1781, 1791, 1801, 1811, 1821, 1831, 1841, 1851, 1861, 1871, 1881 GUNPY 1051, 1091 HARMAN/KARDON 0721 HALLMARK 0861 HANSEATIC 1001 HARVARD 1051, 1061 HINARI 1001, 1091 HITACHI 0181, 0351, 0671, 0681, 0691, 0701, 0711, 0871, 0941, 0971, 1351 HYPSON 1001 IMA 1051 INDIANA 1001 INFINITY REFERENCE 0101 INTERFUNK 1001 ITT 0611 JANEIL 1131 JBL JCB JENSEN JINXING 0101 0951 0311 1531, 1541, 1551, 1561, 1571, 1621, 1631, 1641, 1651, 1691, 1731 JVC (VICTOR) 0261, 0281, 0641, 0651, 0661, 0841 KAWASHO 0901 KAYPANI 1021 KENWOOD 0361, 1031, 1111 KLOSS 0631, 0721, 1131 KTV 0921, 0941, 1011, 1051, 1111 LEYCO 1001 LG (GOLDSTAR) 0031, 0121, 0351, 0411, 0731, 0741, 0861, 0941, 0971, 1001, 1031, 1111, 1151 LIESENK & TTER 1001 LLOYTRON 0941 LOEWE 1001 LOGIK 0991, 1771 LUXMAN 0351, 0971 LXI 0101, 0621, 0761, 0861, 0981 MAGNAVOX 0101, 0341, 0391, 0401, 0411, 0421, 0581, 0591, 0601, 0611, 0631, 0661, 0961, 1111 MAJESTIC 0991 MARANTZ 0101, 0221, 0361, 1001, 1111 MARK 1001 MATSUI 0271, 0331, 1001 MEDIATOR 1001 MEGATRON 0691, 0861, 1161 MEI 1011 M-ELECTRONIC 1001 MEMOREX 0331, 0571, 0861, 0971, 0981, 0991, 1771 METZ 1791, 1831, 1891, 1901, 1911, 1921, 1931, 1941 MGA 0361, 0561, 0571, 0861, 1031, 1111 MIDLAND 0751, 0761, 0891, 0941, 1151 MITSUBISHI 0221, 0321, 0561, 0571, 0661, 0861, 1031, 1101, 1381 MONTGOMERY 1091 MOTOROLA 1041, 1141 MTC 0351, 0361, 0881, 0931, 0971, 1011, 1031, 1111 MULTITECH 0881, 1051 NAD 0551, 0621, 0861 NEC 0241, 0351, 0361, 0661, 0971, 1031, 1111, 1321, 1711 NECKERMANN 1001 NEI 1001 NIKKAI 0271, 0431, 1001, 1151 NIKKO 0861, 1111, 1121 NOVABEAM 0721 NTC 1121 ONWA 1051 OPTIMUS 0551 OPTONICA 0541, 1141 ORION 0831, 1001 OSAKI 0271, 1151 OTTO VERSAND 1001 PANASONIC 0101, 0191, 0251, 0751, 1041, 1311, 1371, 1431 PANDA 1541, 1721 PENNY 0161, 0361, 0521, 0531, 0621, 0731, 0751, 0761, 0781, 0791, 0861, 0931, 0941, 1031, 1041, 1111, 1151, 1161 PEONY 1561, 1621 PHILCO 0361, 0581, 0591, 0601, 0611, 0631, 0961, 1031, 1111 PHILIPS 0101, 0401, 1001 PHONOLA 1001 PILOT 0941, 1031, 1111 PIONEER 0511, 0551, 0871 PORTLAND 0941, 1031, 1121 PRICECLUB 0931 PRISM 0751 PROSCAN 0761 PROTECH 1001 PROTON 0501, 0861, 0941, 1021, 1161 PULSAR 0891 PULSER 1031 QUASAR 0251, 0751, 1041 QUELLE 1001 RADIO SHACK 0541, 0941, 1031, 1051, 1151 RADIOLA 1001 RCA 0051, 0141, 0151, 0181, 0411, 0491, 0531, 0761, 0771, 0871, 1031 REALISTIC 0541, 0861, 0941, 0971, 0981, 1031, 1051, 1111, 1151 RHAPSODY 1011 R-LINE 1001 RUNCO 0891, 1111 SAISHO 0331, 1081 SAMPO 0361, 0941, 1021, 1111, 1151 SAMSUNG 0331, 0341, 0351, 0361, 0861, 0931, 0941, 0971, 1001, 1031, 1111, 1151 SAMSUX 0941 i 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page ii Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM SANYO 0171, 0231, 0271, 0661, 0801, 0911, 0981, 1231, 1251, 1261 SBR 1001 SCHEIDER 1001 SCIMITSU 1031 SCOTCH 0861 SCOTT 0831, 0861, 0941, 1031, 1051, 1091 SEARS 0101, 0161, 0171, 0351, 0481, 0521, 0621, 0761, 0801, 0861, 0971, 0981, 1091 SHANGHAI 1561, 1681 SHARP 0461, 0471, 0541, 0661, 0911, 0941, 1141 SHOGUN 1031 SIGNATURE 0991, 1771 SIMPSON 0581, 0961 SOLAVOX 1151 SONOKO 1001 SONTEC 1001 SONY 0371, 0451, 0661, 0841, 0951, 1281, 1441 SOUNDESIGN 0861, 0961, 1051, 1091 SOUNDWAVE 1001 SPECTRICON 1161 SQUAREVIEW 0481 SSS 1031, 1051 STAR-LITE 1051 SUPREM 0951 SUPRE-MACY 1131 SURPA 0351, 0971 SYLVANIA 0101, 0361, 0441, 0581, 0591, 0601, 0611, 0631, 0961, 1111 SYMPHONIC 0481 SYSLINE 1001 TANDY 0271, 0431, 1141 TATUNG 0271, 0881, 1001, 1041, 1161 TCL 1561, 1631, 1701 TECHNICS 0751 TECHWOOD 0351, 0751, 0971 TEKNIKA 0101, 0351, 0571, 0931, 0941, 0961, 0971, 0991, 1031, 1051, 1091, 1121, 1131, 1771 TELETECH 0331 TERA 0501 THAKRAL 1671 THORM 1001 TMK 0351, 0861, 0971, 1081 TOSHIBA 0381, 0521, 0621, 0661, 0931, 0981, 1301 TOSONIC 1011 TOTEVISION 0941 TRICAL 0911 UNIVERSAL 0781, 0791 UNIVERSUM 1001 ii VECTOR RESEARCH 0361, 1111 VESTEL 1001 VIDEO CONCEPT 1101 VIDIKRON 0101, 0211 VIDTECH 0861, 1031 VIKING 1131 WARDS 0101, 0361, 0451, 0541, 0581, 0591, 0601, 0611, 0771, 0781, 0791, 0861, 0971, 0991, 1031, 1091, 1111, 1771 WATSON 1001 XOGEGO 1611, 1621, 1661, 1741, 1761 YAMAHA 0361, 1031, 1111 YOKO 1001 ZENITH 0011, 0041, 0891, 0991, 1771 ZONDA 1161 CABLE TV ABC 0256, 0376 ANTRONIX 0136 ARCHER 0136, 0286 BBT 0076 CABLETIME 0166 CABLEVISION 0196 COLOUR VOICE 0306, 0346 COMTRONICS 0216, 0276 EAGLE COMTRONICS 0276 EASTERN 0066 ELECTRICORD 0206 ELECTUS 0266 GE 0116, 0126 GEC CABLE SYSTEM 0196 HAMLIN H5 0676 HAMLIN H6 0666 HAMLIN H6S 0656 HAMLIN H8 0646 HAMLIN H9 0636 JERROLD 0256 JERROLD 400L 0626 JERROLD 450L 0616 JERROLD 550 0606 JERROLD OSD CATV 0596 JERROLD SPRUCER 0436 MAGNAVOX/PHILIPS 0416, 0426 MAMM 0296 MEMOREX 0386 MOVIE TIME 0146, 0206 NORTHCOAST 0016 NSC 0146 OAK 0106 OAK SIGMA 450 0546 OAK SIGMA 550 0536 PANASONIC TZ 120/130 0476 PANASONIC TZ 170/180 0446 PANASONIC TZ140 0466 PANASONIC TZ150/160 0456 PARAGON PHILIPS 0386 0036, 0216, 0306, 0316, 0326, 0336, 0346 PIONEER 0006, 0086 PIONEER BR50 0846 PIONEER BR60/70/80/81/82 0696 PIONEER BR90 0556 PULSAR 0386 RCA DIGITAL SATELLITE SYSTEM 0396, 0406 REALISTIC 0136 REGENCY/EASTERN0686 RUNCO 0386 SAMSUNG 0276 SCIENTIFIC ATLANTA 175/475 0576 SCIENTIFIC ATLANTA 75 0366, 0586 SCIENTIFIC ATLANTA 8650 0566 SIGNAL 0276 SL MARX 0276 SPECTAVISION 0236 STANDARD COMPONENTS 0186 STARCOM V 0256 STARGATE 0276 SYLVANIA/TEXSCAN 0376, 0496 TEKNIKA 0176 TELESERVICE 0056 TELEVIEW 0276 TEXSCAN 0186, 0376 TFC 0026 TOCOM 0226, 0356 TOCOM 5503A 0526 TOCOM 5503VIP/5507 0516 TOCOM TC56 0506 TOSHIBA 0386 TUDI 0046 UNIKA 0136 UNIVERSAL 0136, 0156, 0206, 0286 VIDEOWAY 0096 VIEWSTAR 0216 ZENITH 0246, 0386, 0486 SATELLITE TUNER ALPHA STAR 0826 CHAPARRAL 0756 ECHOSTAR 0836 GENERAL INSTRUMENT 0776, 0876 HTS 0836 HUGHES NETWORK SYSTEMS 0816 JERROLD 0776, 0786 PANASONIC 0806 PRIMESTAR 0776, 0786 RCA 0766 SONY 0796 (DBS) HITACHI 0856 MAGNAVOX 0886 MEMOREX 0886 PANASONIC 0896 PHILIPS 0886 SONY 0906 STAR CHOICE 0876 TOSHIBA 0866, 0916 UNIDEN 0886 VCR A TANDY ADVENTURA AIKO AIWA AKAI 0902 0992 0982 0992 0262, 0942, 0952, 0962, 0972 AMERICAN HIGH 0932 AMSTRAD 0992 ASA 0002, 0912 ASHA 0922 AUDIO DYNAMICS 0202 AUDIOVOX 0912 BEAUMARK 0922 BELL & HOWELL 0902 BLAUPUNKT 0412 BROKSONIC 0872, 0882, 0892 BUSH 0852 CALIX 0912 CANON 0862, 0932 CCE 0852, 0982 CITIZEN 0912, 0982 COLT 0852 CRAIG 0832, 0842, 0852, 0912, 0922 CURTIS MATHES 0662, 0822, 0932 CYBERNEX 0922 DAEWOO 0802, 0812, 0982 DBX 0202 DYNATECH 0472, 0992 ELECTROHOME 0912 ELECTROPHONIC 0912 EMEREX 0792 EMERSON 0072, 0132, 0142, 0152, 0162, 0172, 0182, 0192, 0212, 0702, 0712, 0722, 0732, 0742, 0752, 0762, 0772, 0782, 0872, 0882, 0892, 0912, 0952, 0992, 1072 FINLUX 0002, 0992 FISHER 0682, 0692, 0842, 0902 FUJI 0672, 0932 FUNAI 0992 GARRARD 0992 GE 0662, 0822, 0932 GO VIDEO 0642, 0652 GOODMANS 0402 GRADIENTE 0992 GRANDA 0612, 0902 GRUNDIG 0002 HARLEY DAVIDSON 0992 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page iii Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM HARMAN/KARDON 0632, 1082 HARWOOD 0752, 0852 HEADQUARTER 0612 HI-Q 0842 HINARI 0852 HITACHI 0102, 0562, 0572, 0582, 0592, 0602, 0992 ITT 0942 JVC (VICTOR) 0202, 0522, 0532, 0542, 0552 KENWOOD 0202, 0542, 0612, 0632, 0902 KLH 0852 KODAK 0912, 0932 LG (GOLDSTAR) 0082, 0632, 0912 LLOYD 0992 LOGIK 0852 LUXOR 0942 LXI 0022, 0912 MAGNAVOX 0002, 0482, 0492, 0502, 0512, 0932 MAGNIN 0922 MARANTZ 0002, 0202, 0402, 0632, 0932 MARTA 0912 MATSUSHITA 0932 MATSUI 0722 MEI 0222, 0932 MEMOREX 0232, 0242, 0472, 0512, 0612, 0842, 0902, 0912, 0922, 0932, 0992 MGA 0762, 0952 MGA TECHNOLOGY 0922 MINOLTA 0592, 0602 MITSUBISHI 0452, 0462, 0542, 0762, 0952, 1082 MOTOROLA 0472, 0932 MTC 0922, 0992 MULTITECH 0852, 0992 NAD 0442 NEC 0122, 0202, 0292, 0422, 0432, 0542, 0632 NIKKO 0912 NOBLEX 0922 OLYMPUS 0412, 0932 OPTIMUS 0442, 0472, 0912 OPTONICA 0402 ORION 0212, 0722, 0742, 0772 OSAKI 0912 PANASONIC 0012, 0052, 0092, 0222, 0372, 0382, 0392, 0412, 0932 PENNY 0202, 0432, 0602, 0632, 0692, 0912, 0922, 0932 PENTAX 0592, 0602 PERDIO 0992 PHILCO 0002, 0932 PHILIPS 0002, 0282, 0402, 0492, 0932 PILOT 0912 PIONEER 0442, 0542 PROSCAN 1002, 1012, 1022, 1032, 1042, 1052, 1062 PULSAR 0512 QUARTER 0612 QUARTZ 0272, 0612 QUASAR 0382, 0392, 0932 RADIO SHACK 0912, 0992 RADIX 0912 RANDEX 0912 RCA 0112, 0382, 0392, 0482, 0592, 0602, 0662, 0822, 0942 REALISTIC 0402, 0472, 0612, 0682, 0842, 0902, 0912, 0922, 0932, 0992 RICOH 0352, 0362 SAISHO 0212, 0582, 0722, 0732, 0742, 0772 SALORA 0612, 0762 SAMSUNG 0212, 0312, 0922, 0962 SANKY 0472, 0512 SANSUI 0292, 0542, 0832 SANYO 0242, 0612, 0842, 0902, 0922 SBR 0002, 0282 SCHEIDER 0852 SCOTT 0342, 0712, 0762, 0872, 0882, 0892 SEARS 0302, 0592, 0602, 0612, 0682, 0692, 0842, 0902, 0912, 0932 SHARP 0402, 0472 SHINTOM 0852 SHOGUN 0922 SINGER 0852 SONY 0032, 0332, 0352, 0362, 0672, 0792, 0932 STS 0602 SUNPAK 0352 SYLVANIA 0002, 0492, 0502, 0762, 0932, 0992 SYMPHONIC 0992 TANDY 0992 TASHIKO 0712, 0992 TEAC 0992 TECHNICS 0932 TEKNIKA 0322, 0912, 0932, 0992 TELEFUNKEN 0252 TMK 0212, 0732, 0772, 0922 TOSHIBA 0062, 0302, 0342, 0622, 0682, 0712, 0762 TOTEVISION 0912, 0922 UNITECH 0922 VECTOR RESEARCH 0202, 0432, 0632 VIDEO CONCEPTS 0202, 0432, 0632, 0952 WARDS 0322, 0402, 0472, 0482, 0602, 0712, 0842, 0852, 0922, 0932, 0992 YAMAHA ZENITH 0202, 0632 0042, 0362, 0512, 0672 DVD PLAYER AKAI 0058 AIWA 0218 DENON 0188 HITACHI 0198 JVC (VICTOR) 0088, 0178 KENWOOD 0148 LG (GOLDSTAR) 0228 MAGNAVOX 0128 MITSUBISHI 0138 ONKYO 0068, 0128 PANASONIC 0028 PHILIPS 0098, 0128 PIONEER 0108, 0118 PROSCAN 0158 RCA 0158 SAMSUNG 0078 SHARP 0038 SONY 0018 TECHNICS 0028 THOMSON 0168 TOSHIBA 0048, 0128 YAMAHA 0008, 0028, 0098 ZENITH 0128 DVD RECORDER PANASONIC PHILIPS PIONEER TOSHIBA YAMAHA 0238, 0248, 0258 0208 0278, 0288, 0298 0268 0208 LD PLAYER AIWA 0157 DENON 0147 DISCO VISION0017 FUNAI 0157 HITACHI (E) 0017 KENWOOD 0087, 0107 MAGNAVOX 0027 MARANTZ 0027 MITSUBISHI 0137 NAD 0137 PANASONIC 0077, 0177 PHILIPS 0027 PIONEER 0017, 0037, 0137 RCA 0167 REALISTIC 0157 SHARP 0127 SONY 0047, 0057, 0117 VICTOR 0097 YAMAHA 0007, 0067 CD PLAYER ACOUSTIC RESEARCH 1295 ADC 0025, 0065 ADCOM 0205, 0255, 1015 ADS 0265 AIWA 0295, 0945, 1035, 1055 AKAI 0175, 0485, 0535 ALPINE 1215, 1305 AUDIO-TECHNICA 0545 BSR 0245, 0655, 0775 CALIFORNIA AUDIO LAB 0055 CAPETRONIC 1205 CARRERA 0245 CARVER 0285, 1135 CASIO 0345 CROWN 0185 CURTIS MATHES 0345 DENON 0275, 0875, 0885 DEUAL (E) 0505 DYNAMIC BASS (H) 0555 EMERSON 0205, 0325, 1105 EROICA 1275 FISHER 0095, 0555, 0925, 1005 GARRARD 0365 GENEXXA 0305, 0325, 1105 HARMAN/KARDON 0105, 0175, 0465, 0995 HITACHI 0195, 0205, 0505, 0815 INKEL 0115, 0395 JVC (VICTOR) 0315 KENWOOD 0045, 0095, 0405, 0585, 0725, 0735, 0745, 0755, 0895 KYOCERA 0025 LG (GOLDSTAR) 1135, 1225, 1265, 1335 LUXMAN 0075, 0425, 0675, 0705, 0715, 0985 MAGNAVOX 0165, 0215, 0645, 0955 MARANTZ 0215, 0235, 0375, 0785, 1345 MCINTOSH 0355, 1085 MCS 0905, 1315 MEMOREX 0205, 0225, 0235, 0305, 0325, 1105 MGA 0135 MISSION 0215 MITSUBISHI 0135, 0445 MTC 1255 NAD 0035, 0615, 0685, 0695 NAKAMICHI 0125, 0435, 0515 NEC 0255, 0905, 0965 NIKKO 0545, 1005 ONKYO 0155, 0455, 0495, 0805, 1155 OPTIMUS 0225, 0245, 0555, 0595, 0845, 0855, 0865, 0895, 0935 PANASONIC 0055, 0825, 1095, 1125 PENNY 0905 PHILIPS 0165, 0215 PIONEER 0305, 0935, 1045 PROTON 0215, 1185 QUASAR 0055 RCA 0205, 0915, 1115 REALISTIC 0205, 0225, 0235, 0325, 0555, 0845 REVOX 1175 ROTEL 0215 SABA TELECOMMANDER (E) 0505 iii 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page iv Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM SAE SAMSUNG SANSUI 0215 1285 0215, 0625, 0975, 1025, 1105 SANYO 0145, 0555, 0635, 0765 SCOTT 0325, 1105 SEARS 0345 SHARP 0235, 0665, 0895, 1065, 1075 SHERWOOD 0115, 0235, 0395, 0475 SIEMENTS GARRARD 1245 SIGNATURE 0175 SONTEC 1165 SONY 0065, 0565, 0865, 1145 STARON 1235 STS 0025 SYLVANIA 0215 SYMPHONIC 0335 TANDY 0305 TANGBERG 1195 TEAC 0235, 0335, 0385, 0525, 0795, 0835, 1355 TECHNICS 0055, 0605, 1095 TECHWOOD 1325 TELEFUNKEN (E) 0505 THOMSON (E) 0505 TOSHIBA 0035, 0685 VECTOR RESEARCH 0065, 1135 WARDS 0175 YAMAHA 0005, 0015, 0085, 0415, 0545, 0575, 1065 CD RECORDER HITACHI JVC (VICTOR) MARANTZ PHILIPS PIONEER YAMAHA 0474 0504 0484, 0494 0444 0454 0414 MD RECORDER KENWOOD PIONEER SHARP SONY YAMAHA 0384 0424 0434 0394 0024, 0394, 0404, 0514 TAPE DECK AIWA AKAI CARVER DENON FISHER GARRARD JVC (VICTOR) KENWOOD MAGNAVOX MARANTZ MITSUBISHI iv 0094, 0214, 0224 0184 0094 0304 0144 0194, 0204 0274, 0284, 0294 0124, 0134, 0154, 0234, 0244, 0264 0094 0094, 0344 0184 OPTIMUS ONKYO PHILIPS PIONEER REVOX SANSUI SHARP SHERWOOD SONY TEAC TECHNICS WARDS YAMAHA 0034, 0064, 0204, 0334 0364, 0374 0094 0034, 0044, 0064 0354 0094, 0344 0264 0334 0054, 0084, 0324 0194, 0254 0074, 0314 0034 0004, 0014, 0104, 0114, 0164, 0174, 0264 00_RXV550_U_EN.book Page 1 Tuesday, February 17, 2004 9:21 AM © 2004 YAMAHA ELECTRONICS CORPORATION, USA 6660 ORANGETHORPE AVE., BUENA PARK, CALIF. 90620, U.S.A. YAMAHA CANADA MUSIC LTD. 135 MILNER AVE., SCARBOROUGH, ONTARIO M1S 3R1, CANADA YAMAHA ELECTRONIK EUROPA G.m.b.H. SIEMENSSTR. 22-34, 25462 RELLINGEN BEI HAMBURG, F.R. OF GERMANY YAMAHA ELECTRONIQUE FRANCE S.A. RUE AMBROISE CROIZAT BP70 CROISSY-BEAUBOURG 77312 MARNE-LA-VALLEE CEDEX02, FRANCE YAMAHA ELECTRONICS (UK) LTD. YAMAHA HOUSE, 200 RICKMANSWORTH ROAD WATFORD, HERTS WD18 7GQ, ENGLAND YAMAHA SCANDINAVIA A.B. J A WETTERGRENS GATA 1, BOX 30053, 400 43 VÄSTRA FRÖLUNDA, SWEDEN YAMAHA MUSIC AUSTRALIA PTY, LTD. 17-33 MARKET ST., SOUTH MELBOURNE, 3205 VIC., AUSTRALIA All rights reserved. Printed in Malaysia WC85400
  • Page 1 1
  • Page 2 2
  • Page 3 3
  • Page 4 4
  • Page 5 5
  • Page 6 6
  • Page 7 7
  • Page 8 8
  • Page 9 9
  • Page 10 10
  • Page 11 11
  • Page 12 12
  • Page 13 13
  • Page 14 14
  • Page 15 15
  • Page 16 16
  • Page 17 17
  • Page 18 18
  • Page 19 19
  • Page 20 20
  • Page 21 21
  • Page 22 22
  • Page 23 23
  • Page 24 24
  • Page 25 25
  • Page 26 26
  • Page 27 27
  • Page 28 28
  • Page 29 29
  • Page 30 30
  • Page 31 31
  • Page 32 32
  • Page 33 33
  • Page 34 34
  • Page 35 35
  • Page 36 36
  • Page 37 37
  • Page 38 38
  • Page 39 39
  • Page 40 40
  • Page 41 41
  • Page 42 42
  • Page 43 43
  • Page 44 44
  • Page 45 45
  • Page 46 46
  • Page 47 47
  • Page 48 48
  • Page 49 49
  • Page 50 50
  • Page 51 51
  • Page 52 52
  • Page 53 53
  • Page 54 54
  • Page 55 55
  • Page 56 56
  • Page 57 57
  • Page 58 58
  • Page 59 59
  • Page 60 60
  • Page 61 61
  • Page 62 62
  • Page 63 63
  • Page 64 64
  • Page 65 65
  • Page 66 66
  • Page 67 67
  • Page 68 68
  • Page 69 69
  • Page 70 70
  • Page 71 71
  • Page 72 72
  • Page 73 73
  • Page 74 74
  • Page 75 75
  • Page 76 76
  • Page 77 77
  • Page 78 78
  • Page 79 79

Yamaha RX-550 El manual del propietario

Categoría
Receptores AV
Tipo
El manual del propietario
Este manual también es adecuado para